blob: 803d42edcfa5af2ee63f7d571d6f92efd48b2c71 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
781 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
782 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
783 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
784 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
785 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200786
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200787tune.bufsize <number>
788 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
789 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
790 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
791 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
792 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
793 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
794 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
795 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400796 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
797 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
798 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200799
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200800tune.chksize <number>
801 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
802 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
803 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
804 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
805 checks whenever possible.
806
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100807tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
808 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
809 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
810 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
811 this value. The default value is 1.
812
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100813tune.http.cookielen <number>
814 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
815 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
816 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
817 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
818 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
819 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
820 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
821 to change this value.
822
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200823tune.http.maxhdr <number>
824 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
825 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
826 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
827 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
828 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
829 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
830 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
831 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
832 limit too high.
833
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100834tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100835 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
836 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
837 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
838 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
839 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
840 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
841 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
842 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
843 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
844 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100845
846tune.maxpollevents <number>
847 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
848 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
849 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
850 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
851 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
852
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200853tune.maxrewrite <number>
854 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
855 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
856 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
857 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
858 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
859 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
860 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
861 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
862 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
863 bufsize.
864
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200865tune.pipesize <number>
866 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
867 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
868 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
869 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
870 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
871 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
872
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100873tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
874tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
875 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
876 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
877 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
878 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
879 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
880 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
881 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
882
883tune.sndbuf.client <number>
884tune.sndbuf.server <number>
885 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
886 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
887 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
888 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
889 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
890 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
891 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
892 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
893 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
894 notifying haproxy again.
895
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100896tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100897 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
898 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
899 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
900 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
901 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
902 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
903 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
904 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
905 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100906 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
907 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100908
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100909tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
910 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
911 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
912 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
913 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
914 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
915 being used for too long.
916
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100917tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
918 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
919 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
920 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
921 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
922 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
923 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
924 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
925 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
926 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
927 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
928 best value.
929
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100930tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
931 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
932 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
933 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
934 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
935 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
936
937tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
938 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
939 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
940 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
941 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009433.3. Debugging
944--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946debug
947 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
948 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
949 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
950 system startup.
951
952quiet
953 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
954 line argument "-q".
955
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009573.4. Userlists
958--------------
959It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
960http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
961it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
962
963userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100964 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100965 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
966
967group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100968 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100969 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
970 proceeded by "users" keyword.
971
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100972user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
973 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100974 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
975 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100976 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
977 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100978 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
979 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
980
981
982 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100983 userlist L1
984 group G1 users tiger,scott
985 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100987 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
988 user scott insecure-password elgato
989 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100990
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100991 userlist L2
992 group G1
993 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100994
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100995 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
996 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
997 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100998
999 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001000
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001001
10023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001003----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001004It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1005haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1006pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1007identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1008or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1009Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1010known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1011the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1012process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1013during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1014tables.
1015
1016peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001017 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001018 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1019
1020peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1021 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1022 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1023 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1024 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1025 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1026 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1027
1028 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1029 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1030
1031 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1032 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1033 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1034 across all peers.
1035
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001036 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1037 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1038 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1039
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001040 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001041 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001042 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1043 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1044 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001045
1046 backend mybackend
1047 mode tcp
1048 balance roundrobin
1049 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1050 stick on src
1051
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001052 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1053 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001054
1055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010564. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001058
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001059Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1060 - defaults <name>
1061 - frontend <name>
1062 - backend <name>
1063 - listen <name>
1064
1065A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1066its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1067section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001068section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069
1070A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1071connections.
1072
1073A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1074to forward incoming connections.
1075
1076A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1077parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001079All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1080'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1081case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1082
1083Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1084logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1085proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1086However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1087name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1088
1089Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1090and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001091bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1093modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1094arbitrary criteria.
1095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010974.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1098--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001100The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1101limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1102they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1103limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001104marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001105option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001106and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1107with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1108specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001111 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1112------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1113acl - X X X
1114appsession - - X X
1115backlog X X X -
1116balance X - X X
1117bind - X X -
1118bind-process X X X X
1119block - X X X
1120capture cookie - X X -
1121capture request header - X X -
1122capture response header - X X -
1123clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001124compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001125contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1126cookie X - X X
1127default-server X - X X
1128default_backend X X X -
1129description - X X X
1130disabled X X X X
1131dispatch - - X X
1132enabled X X X X
1133errorfile X X X X
1134errorloc X X X X
1135errorloc302 X X X X
1136-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1137errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001138force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139fullconn X - X X
1140grace X X X X
1141hash-type X - X X
1142http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001143http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001144http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001145http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001146http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001147http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001148id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001149ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001150log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001151maxconn X X X -
1152mode X X X X
1153monitor fail - X X -
1154monitor-net X X X -
1155monitor-uri X X X -
1156option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1157option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1158option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1159option allbackups (*) X - X X
1160option checkcache (*) X - X X
1161option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1162option contstats (*) X X X -
1163option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1164option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1165option forceclose (*) X X X X
1166-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1167option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001168option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001169option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001170option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1171option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1172option httpchk X - X X
1173option httpclose (*) X X X X
1174option httplog X X X X
1175option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001176option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001177option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001178option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1179option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1180option logasap (*) X X X -
1181option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001182option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001183option nolinger (*) X X X X
1184option originalto X X X X
1185option persist (*) X - X X
1186option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001187option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001188option smtpchk X - X X
1189option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1190option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1191option splice-request (*) X X X X
1192option splice-response (*) X X X X
1193option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1194option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1195-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1196option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1197option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1198option tcpka X X X X
1199option tcplog X X X X
1200option transparent (*) X - X X
1201persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1202rate-limit sessions X X X -
1203redirect - X X X
1204redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1205redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1206reqadd - X X X
1207reqallow - X X X
1208reqdel - X X X
1209reqdeny - X X X
1210reqiallow - X X X
1211reqidel - X X X
1212reqideny - X X X
1213reqipass - X X X
1214reqirep - X X X
1215reqisetbe - X X X
1216reqitarpit - X X X
1217reqpass - X X X
1218reqrep - X X X
1219-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1220reqsetbe - X X X
1221reqtarpit - X X X
1222retries X - X X
1223rspadd - X X X
1224rspdel - X X X
1225rspdeny - X X X
1226rspidel - X X X
1227rspideny - X X X
1228rspirep - X X X
1229rsprep - X X X
1230server - - X X
1231source X - X X
1232srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001233stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234stats auth X - X X
1235stats enable X - X X
1236stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001237stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238stats realm X - X X
1239stats refresh X - X X
1240stats scope X - X X
1241stats show-desc X - X X
1242stats show-legends X - X X
1243stats show-node X - X X
1244stats uri X - X X
1245-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1246stick match - - X X
1247stick on - - X X
1248stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001249stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001251tcp-request connection - X X -
1252tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001253tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001254tcp-response content - - X X
1255tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256timeout check X - X X
1257timeout client X X X -
1258timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1259timeout connect X - X X
1260timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1261timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1262timeout http-request X X X X
1263timeout queue X - X X
1264timeout server X - X X
1265timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1266timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001267timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001268transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001269unique-id-format X X X -
1270unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001272use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1274 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012774.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1278---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001279
1280This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1281
1282
1283acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1284 Declare or complete an access list.
1285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1286 no | yes | yes | yes
1287 Example:
1288 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1289 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1290 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001292 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293
1294
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001295appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1296 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001297 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1299 no | no | yes | yes
1300 Arguments :
1301 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1302 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1303
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001304 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305 checked in each cookie value.
1306
1307 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1308 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1309 milliseconds.
1310
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001311 request-learn
1312 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1313 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1314 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1315 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1316 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1317 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1318
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001319 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1320 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1321 data following this prefix.
1322
1323 Example :
1324 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1325
1326 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1327 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1328
1329 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1330 2 modes are currently supported :
1331 - path-parameters :
1332 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1333 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1334 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1335 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1336 - query-string :
1337 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1338 query string.
1339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001340 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1341 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1342 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1343 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001344 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1345 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1346 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001347 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1348 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1349
1350 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1351
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001352 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1353 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1354 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001356 Example :
1357 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1358
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001359 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1360 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
1362
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001363backlog <conns>
1364 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1366 yes | yes | yes | no
1367 Arguments :
1368 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1369 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001370 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001371
1372 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1373 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1374 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1375 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1376 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1377 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1378 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1379 backlog parameter.
1380
1381 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1382 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1383 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1384
1385 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1386
1387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001389balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001390 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1392 yes | no | yes | yes
1393 Arguments :
1394 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1395 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1396 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1397 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1398
1399 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1400 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1401 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1402 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001403 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001404 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001405 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1406 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1407 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1408 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1409 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1410 it, so that you don't worry.
1411
1412 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1413 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1414 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1415 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1416 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1417 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1418 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1419 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001421 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1422 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1423 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1424 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1425 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1426 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1427 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1428 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1429
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001430 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1431 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1432 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1433 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001434 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001435 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1436 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1437 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1438 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1439 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001440 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1441 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1442 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1443 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1444 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1445 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1448 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1449 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1450 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1451 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1452 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1453 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1454 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001455 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001457 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1458 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1459 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001461 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1462 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1463 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1464 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1465 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1466 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1467 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1468 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1469 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1470 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1471 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1472 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001474 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001475 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1476 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1477 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1478 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1479 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1480 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1481 URIs start with a leading "/".
1482
1483 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1484 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1485 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1486 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1487
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001489 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1490
1491 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001492 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1493 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1494 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1495 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1496 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1497 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1498 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1499 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1500 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1501 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1502 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1503 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1504 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1505 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1506 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1507 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1508 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1509 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1510 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001511
1512 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1513 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1514 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1515 server will receive the request.
1516
1517 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1518 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1519 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1520 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1521 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001522 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1523 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1524 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001525
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001526 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1527 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1528 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1529 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1530 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001532 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001533 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1534 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1535 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1536
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001537 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1538 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1539 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1540
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001541 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001542 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001543 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1544 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1545 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1546 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1547 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1548 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001549 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001550 used instead.
1551
1552 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1553 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1554 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1555 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1556
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001557 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1558 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1559 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1560
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001561 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001563 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001564 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1565 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001566
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001567 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001568 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001569
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001570 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1571 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1572 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
1574 Examples :
1575 balance roundrobin
1576 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001577 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001578 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1579 balance hdr(host)
1580 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001581
1582 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1583 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001585 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001586 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1587 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1588 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1589 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1590
1591 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1592 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1593 defaults to 16 kB.
1594
1595 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1596 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1597
1598 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1599 Round Robin.
1600
1601 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1602 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1603 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1604 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1605
1606 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1607
1608 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001609 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001610 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1611 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1612 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001613
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001614 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1615 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001616
1617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001618bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1619bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1622 no | yes | yes | no
1623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001624 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1625 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1626 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1627 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001628 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001629 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1630 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1631 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1632 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1633 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1634 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1635 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001636 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1637 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1638 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001639 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1640 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1641 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1642 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001643
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001644 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1645 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001646 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1647 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1648 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001649 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1650 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1651 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1652 the range.
1653
1654 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1655 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1656 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1657 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1658 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1659 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1660 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001661 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001662 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001664 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1665 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1666 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1667 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1668 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1669 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1670 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1671 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001673 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1674 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1675 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1676 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1679 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1680 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1681 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1682 in a frontend.
1683
1684 Example :
1685 listen http_proxy
1686 bind :80,:443
1687 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001688 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001689
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001690 listen http_https_proxy
1691 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001692 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001693
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001694 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1695 bind ipv6@:80
1696 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1697 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1698
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001699 listen external_bind_app1
1700 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1701
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001702 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001703 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001706bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001707 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1709 yes | yes | yes | yes
1710 Arguments :
1711 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1712 may be used to override a default value.
1713
1714 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1715 option may be combined with other numbers.
1716
1717 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1718 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1719 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1720 missing from all processes.
1721
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001722 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1723 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1724 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1725 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1726 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001727
1728 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1729 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1730 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1731 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1732 and 'even' instances.
1733
1734 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1735 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1736 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1737 32.
1738
1739 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1740 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1741
1742 Example :
1743 listen app_ip1
1744 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001745 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001746
1747 listen app_ip2
1748 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001749 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001750
1751 listen management
1752 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001753 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001754
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001755 listen management
1756 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1757 bind-process 1-4
1758
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001759 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1760
1761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762block { if | unless } <condition>
1763 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1765 no | yes | yes | yes
1766
1767 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1768 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001769 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001770 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1772 "block" statements per instance.
1773
1774 Example:
1775 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1776 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1777 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1778 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
1782
1783capture cookie <name> len <length>
1784 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 no | yes | yes | no
1787 Arguments :
1788 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1789 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1790 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1791 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1792 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1793
1794 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1795 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1796 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1797 right if it exceeds <length>.
1798
1799 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1800 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1801 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1802 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1803
1804 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1805 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1806 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1807
1808 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1809 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1810 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001811 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1812 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1813 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
1815 Example:
1816 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1817
1818 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001820
1821
1822capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001823 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1825 no | yes | yes | no
1826 Arguments :
1827 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001828 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1830 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1831 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1832
1833 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1834 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1835 it exceeds <length>.
1836
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001837 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1839 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001840 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1841 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1842 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1843 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001844 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001845 environments to find where the request came from.
1846
1847 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1848 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1849 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1850 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001852 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1853 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1854 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1855 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1856 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858 Example:
1859 capture request header Host len 15
1860 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1861 capture request header Referrer len 15
1862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001863 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001864 about logging.
1865
1866
1867capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001868 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1870 no | yes | yes | no
1871 Arguments :
1872 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001873 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1875 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1876 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1877
1878 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1879 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1880 it exceeds <length>.
1881
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001882 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1884 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1885 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001886 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1887 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1888 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1889 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001891 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1892 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1893 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1894 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1895 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896
1897 Example:
1898 capture response header Content-length len 9
1899 capture response header Location len 15
1900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001901 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902 about logging.
1903
1904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1908 yes | yes | yes | no
1909 Arguments :
1910 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1912 as explained at the top of this document.
1913
1914 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1915 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1916 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1917 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1918 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1919 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1920 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1921 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001922 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001923 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1924 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1925
1926 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1927 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1928 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1929 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1930 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1931 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1932
1933 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1934 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1935
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001936 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1937 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001939compression algo <algorithm> ...
1940compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001941compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001942 Enable HTTP compression.
1943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1944 yes | yes | yes | yes
1945 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001946 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1947 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1948 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1949
1950 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001951 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001952 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1953 data.
1954
1955 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1956 support for zlib was built in.
1957
1958 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1959 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1960 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1961 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1962 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1963 in.
1964
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001965 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001966 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001967 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1968 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1969 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1970 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1971 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001972
1973 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1974 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1975 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1976 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1977 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001978 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1979 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1980 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1981 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1982 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1983 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001984
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001985 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001986 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1987 "Accept-Encoding" header
1988 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001989 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001990 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1991 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1992 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1993 "multipart"
1994 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1995 header
1996 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1997 and later
1998 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1999 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002000
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002001 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2002 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002003
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002004 Examples :
2005 compression algo gzip
2006 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002008contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002009 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2011 yes | no | yes | yes
2012 Arguments :
2013 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2015 as explained at the top of this document.
2016
2017 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002018 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002019 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2021 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2022 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2023 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2024
2025 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2026 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2027 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2028 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2029 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2030 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2031
2032 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2033 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2034 instead.
2035
2036 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2037 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2038
2039
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002040cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002041 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2042 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2045 yes | no | yes | yes
2046 Arguments :
2047 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2048 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2049 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2050 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2051 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2052 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2053 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2054 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2055 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2056
2057 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2058 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2059 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2060 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2061 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2062 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2063 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2064 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2065 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2066 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2067 "insert" and "prefix".
2068
2069 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002070 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002071
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002072 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002073 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2074 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2075 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2076 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2077 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2078 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2079 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2080 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2081 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2082 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
2084 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2085 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2086 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2087 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2088 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2089 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2090 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2091 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2092 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2093 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002094 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2095 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2096 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002098 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2099 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2100 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002101 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2102 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2103 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2104 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002105 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2106 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2107 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108
2109 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2110 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2111 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2112 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2113 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2114 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2115 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2116 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2117 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2118
2119 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2120 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2121 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2122 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2123 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2124 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2125 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2126 persistence cookie in the cache.
2127 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2128
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002129 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2130 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2131 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2132 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2133 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2134 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2135 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2136 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2137 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2138 they logout.
2139
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002140 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2141 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2142 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2143 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2144
2145 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2146 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2147 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2148 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2149 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2150 this attribute.
2151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002152 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002153 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002154 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2155 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2156 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2157 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2158 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2159 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002160
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002161 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2162 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2163 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2164 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2165 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2166 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2167 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2168 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2169 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2170 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2171 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2172 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2173 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2174 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2175 the site.
2176
2177 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2178 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2179 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2180 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2181 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2182 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2183 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2184 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2185 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2186 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2187 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2188 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2189 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2190 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2191 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2192 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2195 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2196 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2197 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199 Examples :
2200 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2201 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2202 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002203 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002205 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002206 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002209default-server [param*]
2210 Change default options for a server in a backend
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 yes | no | yes | yes
2213 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002214 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2215 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2216 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2217 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002218
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002219 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002220 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2221
2222 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002225default_backend <backend>
2226 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2228 yes | yes | yes | no
2229 Arguments :
2230 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2231
2232 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2233 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2234 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2235 will catch all undetermined requests.
2236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237 Example :
2238
2239 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2240 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2241 default_backend dynamic
2242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002243 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002246description <string>
2247 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 no | yes | yes | yes
2250 Arguments : string
2251
2252 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2253 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2254 it describes.
2255 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2256
2257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258disabled
2259 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2261 yes | yes | yes | yes
2262 Arguments : none
2263
2264 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2265 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2266 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2267 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2268 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2269 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2270 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2271
2272 See also : "enabled"
2273
2274
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002275dispatch <address>:<port>
2276 Set a default server address
2277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2278 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002280
2281 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2282 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2283 during start-up.
2284
2285 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2286 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2287 possible with normal servers.
2288
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002289 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002290 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2291 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2292 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2293 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2294
2295 See also : "server"
2296
2297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298enabled
2299 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 yes | yes | yes | yes
2302 Arguments : none
2303
2304 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2305 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2306
2307 See also : "disabled"
2308
2309
2310errorfile <code> <file>
2311 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2313 yes | yes | yes | yes
2314 Arguments :
2315 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002316 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317
2318 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002319 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002321 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2322 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
2324 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2325 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2326 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002328 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2331 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2332 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2333 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2334
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002335 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2336 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2337 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2338 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2339 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2340 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2343 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2344 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002345 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2347
2348 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2349
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002350 Example :
2351 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2352 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2353 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2354
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002355
2356errorloc <code> <url>
2357errorloc302 <code> <url>
2358 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2360 yes | yes | yes | yes
2361 Arguments :
2362 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002363 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002364
2365 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2366 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2367 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2368 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2369 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2370
2371 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2372 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2373 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2374
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002375 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2376
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2378 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2379 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2380 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2381 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2382 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2383 request.
2384
2385 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2386
2387
2388errorloc303 <code> <url>
2389 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2391 yes | yes | yes | yes
2392 Arguments :
2393 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2394 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2395
2396 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2397 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2398 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2399 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2400 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2401
2402 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2403 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2404 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2405
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002406 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002408 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2409 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2410 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2411 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002412 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002413
2414 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2415
2416
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002417force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2418 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2420 no | yes | yes | yes
2421
2422 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2423 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2424 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2425 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2426 marked down for maintenance operations.
2427
2428 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2429 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2430 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2431 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2432 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2433 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2434 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2435 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2436 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2437
2438 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2439 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2440 is used.
2441
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002442 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002443 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002444
2445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002446fullconn <conns>
2447 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 yes | no | yes | yes
2450 Arguments :
2451 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2452 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2453
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002454 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002455 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002456 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002457 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2458 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2459 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2460 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2461 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002462 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002463
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002464 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2465 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2466 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002468 Example :
2469 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2470 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2471 # connections.
2472 backend dynamic
2473 fullconn 10000
2474 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2475 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2476
2477 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2478
2479
2480grace <time>
2481 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484 Arguments :
2485 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2486 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2487 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2488
2489 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2490 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002491 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002492 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2493
2494 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2495 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2496 simplify it.
2497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002499hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002500 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2502 yes | no | yes | yes
2503 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002504 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2505 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002506
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002507 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2508 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2509 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2510 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2511 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2512 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2513 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2514 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2515 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2516 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002517
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002518 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2519 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2520 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2521 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2522 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2523 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2524 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2525 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2526 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2527 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2528 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2529 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2530 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002531 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2532 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002533
2534 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2535
2536 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2537 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2538 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2539 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002540 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2541 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2542 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002543
2544 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2545 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002546 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2547 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2548 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2549 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2550
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002551 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2552 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2553 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2554 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2555 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2556 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2557 parameter.
2558
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002559 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2560
2561 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2562 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2563 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2564 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2565 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2566 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2567 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2568 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2569 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2570 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2571 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2572 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002573
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002574 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2575 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2576 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002577
2578 See also : "balance", "server"
2579
2580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581http-check disable-on-404
2582 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002584 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002585 Arguments : none
2586
2587 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2588 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2589 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2590 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2591 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2592 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2593 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2594 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002595 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2596 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2597 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2598
2599 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2600
2601
2602http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002603 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002605 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002606 Arguments :
2607 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2608 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002609 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002610 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2611 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2612 details on the supported keywords.
2613
2614 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2615 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2616 with the usual backslash ('\').
2617
2618 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2619 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2620 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2621 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2622 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2623
2624 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002625 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002626 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2627 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2628 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2629
2630 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002631 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002632 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2633 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2634 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2635 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2636
2637 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002638 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002639 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2640 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2641 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2642 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2643 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2644 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2645 trace).
2646
2647 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002648 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002649 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2650 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2651 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2652 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2653 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2654 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2655
2656 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2657 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2658 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2659 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2660 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2661 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2662 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2663 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2664
2665 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2666 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2667
2668 Examples :
2669 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002670 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002671
2672 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002673 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002674
2675 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002676 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002677
2678 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002679 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002681 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002682
2683
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002684http-check send-state
2685 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2687 yes | no | yes | yes
2688 Arguments : none
2689
2690 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2691 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2692 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2693 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2694 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2695
2696 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2697 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2698 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2699 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2700 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2701 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2702 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2703 checked in multiple backends.
2704
2705 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2706 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2707
2708 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2709 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2710 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2711 one fails.
2712
2713 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2714 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2715 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2716
2717 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2718 server's queue.
2719
2720 Example of a header received by the application server :
2721 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2722 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2723
2724 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2725
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002726http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002727 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002728 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2729 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002730 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002731 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2732
2733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2734 no | yes | yes | yes
2735
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002736 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2737 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2738 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2739 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2740 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002741
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002742 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2743 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2744 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2745
2746 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2747 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2748 are evaluated.
2749
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002750 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2751 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2752 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2753 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2754 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2755 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2756 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2757 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2758 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2759 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2760 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2761
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002762 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2763 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2764 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2765 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2766 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2767
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002768 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2769 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2770 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002771 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2772 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002773
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002774 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2775 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2776 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2777 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2778 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2779 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2780 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2781 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2782
2783 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2784 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2785 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2786 external users.
2787
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002788 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2789 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2790 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2791 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2792 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2793 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2794 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2795 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2796
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002797 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2798 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2799 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2800 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2801 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2802 another equipment.
2803
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002804 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2805 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2806 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2807 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2808 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2809 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2810 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2811 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2812
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002813 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2814 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2815 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2816 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2817 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2818 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2819 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2820 admin privileges.
2821
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002822 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2823
2824 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2825 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2826 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2827 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002828
2829 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002830 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2831 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2832 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002833
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002834 http-request allow if nagios
2835 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2836 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2837 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002838
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002839 Example:
2840 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002841 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002842
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002843 Example:
2844 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2845 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2846 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2847 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2848 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2849 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2850 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2851 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2852 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2853
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002854 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2855 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002856
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002857http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002858 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002859 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2860 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002861 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2862
2863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2864 no | yes | yes | yes
2865
2866 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2867 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2868 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2869 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2870 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2871 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2872
2873 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2874 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2875 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2876 current section.
2877
2878 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2879 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2880 rules are evaluated.
2881
2882 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2883 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2884 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2885 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2886 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2887 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2888 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2889
2890 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2891 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2892 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2893 external users.
2894
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002895 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2896 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2897 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2898 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2899 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2900 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2901 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2902 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2903
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002904 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2905 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2906 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2907 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2908 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2909 another equipment.
2910
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002911 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2912 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2913 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2914 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2915 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2916 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2917 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2918 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2919
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002920 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2921 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2922 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2923 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2924 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2925 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2926 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2927 admin privileges.
2928
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002929 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2930
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002931 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002932 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2933 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2934 rules.
2935
2936 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2937 ACL usage.
2938
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002939http-send-name-header [<header>]
2940 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2941
2942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2943 yes | no | yes | yes
2944
2945 Arguments :
2946
2947 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2948
2949 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2950 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2951 is added with the header string proved.
2952
2953 See also : "server"
2954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002955id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002956 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2958 no | yes | yes | yes
2959 Arguments : none
2960
2961 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2962 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2963 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002964
2965
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002966ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2967 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2969 no | yes | yes | yes
2970
2971 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2972 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2973 and running).
2974
2975 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2976 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2977 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2978 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2979 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2980
2981 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2982 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2983
2984 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2985 "unless" condition is met.
2986
2987 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2988
2989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002990log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002991log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002992no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002993 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002996
2997 Prefix :
2998 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2999 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3000 prefix does not allow arguments.
3001
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003002 Arguments :
3003 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3004 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3005 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3006 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3007 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3008 parameter.
3009
3010 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3011 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3012
3013 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3014 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3015 standard syslog port).
3016
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003017 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3018 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3019 standard syslog port).
3020
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003021 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3022 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3023 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3024 appropriately writeable).
3025
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003026 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3027 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3028 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3029 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3030
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003031 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3032
3033 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3034 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3035 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3036
3037 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3038 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3039 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003040 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3041 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3042 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3043 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3044 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003045
3046 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3047
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003048 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3049 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3050 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003051
3052 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3053 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3054 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3055 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3056
3057 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3058 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003059
3060 Example :
3061 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003062 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3063 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003064 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3065
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003066
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003067log-format <string>
3068 Allows you to custom a log line.
3069
3070 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3071
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003072
3073maxconn <conns>
3074 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 yes | yes | yes | no
3077 Arguments :
3078 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3079 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3080 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3081 closes.
3082
3083 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3084 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3085 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3086 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3087 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3088 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3089 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3090 properly tuned.
3091
3092 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3093 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3094 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3095
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003096 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3097
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003098 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3099
3100
3101mode { tcp|http|health }
3102 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3104 yes | yes | yes | yes
3105 Arguments :
3106 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3107 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3108 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3109 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3110
3111 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3112 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3113 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3114 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3115 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3116
3117 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003118 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3119 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3120 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3121 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3122 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3123 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3124 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003125
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003126 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3127 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3128 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003129
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003130 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003131 defaults http_instances
3132 mode http
3133
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003134 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003137monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003138 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141 Arguments :
3142 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3143 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3146 backend and its backup.
3147
3148 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3149 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3150 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3151 servers in a list of backends.
3152
3153 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3154 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3155 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3156 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3157 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3158 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3159 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003160 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3161 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
3163 Example:
3164 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003165 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3167 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3168 monitor-uri /site_alive
3169 monitor fail if site_dead
3170
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003171 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003172
3173
3174monitor-net <source>
3175 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3177 yes | yes | yes | no
3178 Arguments :
3179 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3180 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3181 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3182 followed by a mask.
3183
3184 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3185 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003186 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003187 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3188
3189 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3190 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3191 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3192 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003193 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3194 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3195 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003196
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003197 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3198 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3199 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3200 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3201 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3202 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003203
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003204 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3205 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003206
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003207 Example :
3208 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3209 frontend www
3210 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3211
3212 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3213
3214
3215monitor-uri <uri>
3216 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3218 yes | yes | yes | no
3219 Arguments :
3220 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3221 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3222
3223 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3224 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3225 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3226 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3227 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3228 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3229 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3230 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3231
3232 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3233 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3234 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3235 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3236 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3237 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3238
3239 Example :
3240 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3241 frontend www
3242 mode http
3243 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3244
3245 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003247
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003248option abortonclose
3249no option abortonclose
3250 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3252 yes | no | yes | yes
3253 Arguments : none
3254
3255 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3256 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3257 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3258 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003259 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003260 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3261 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3262 encountered while delivering the response.
3263
3264 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3265 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3266 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3267 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3268 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3269 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003270 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003271 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003272 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003273 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3274 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3275 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3276
3277 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3278 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3279 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3280 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3281 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3282 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3283 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3284 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003285 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003286
3287 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3288 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3289
3290 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3291
3292
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003293option accept-invalid-http-request
3294no option accept-invalid-http-request
3295 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3297 yes | yes | yes | no
3298 Arguments : none
3299
3300 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3301 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3302 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3303 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3304 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3305 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3306 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3307 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003308 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3309 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3310 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3311 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3312 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3313 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003314
3315 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3316 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3317 been confirmed.
3318
3319 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3320 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003321 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3322 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003323 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3324
3325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3327
3328 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3329 stats socket.
3330
3331
3332option accept-invalid-http-response
3333no option accept-invalid-http-response
3334 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | no | yes | yes
3337 Arguments : none
3338
3339 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3340 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3341 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3342 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3343 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3344 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3345 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3346 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3347 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3348
3349 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3350 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3351 been confirmed.
3352
3353 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3354 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3355 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3356 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3357
3358 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3359 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3360
3361 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3362 stats socket.
3363
3364
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003365option allbackups
3366no option allbackups
3367 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | no | yes | yes
3370 Arguments : none
3371
3372 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3373 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3374 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3375 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3376 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3377 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3378 order between the backup servers anymore.
3379
3380 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3381 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3382
3383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3385
3386
3387option checkcache
3388no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003389 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 yes | no | yes | yes
3392 Arguments : none
3393
3394 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3395 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003396 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003397 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3398 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003399 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003400
3401 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003402 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003403 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003404 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3405 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003406 to the client are :
3407 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003408 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003409 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003410 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3411 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3412 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3413 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3414 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3415 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3416 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3417 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3418 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3419 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3420 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3421
3422 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003423 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003424 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003425 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003426 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3427
3428 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3429 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003430 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003431 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3432
3433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3435
3436
3437option clitcpka
3438no option clitcpka
3439 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | yes | yes | no
3442 Arguments : none
3443
3444 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3445 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3446 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3447 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3448
3449 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3450 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3451 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3452 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3453
3454 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3455 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3456 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3457 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3458 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3459
3460 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3461
3462 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3463 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3464 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3465
3466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3468
3469 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3470
3471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472option contstats
3473 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | yes | yes | no
3476 Arguments : none
3477
3478 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3479 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3480 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3481 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3482 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3483 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3484 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3485
3486
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003487option dontlog-normal
3488no option dontlog-normal
3489 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3491 yes | yes | yes | no
3492 Arguments : none
3493
3494 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3495 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3496 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3497 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3498 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3499 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3500 logged.
3501
3502 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3503 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3504 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003506 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003507 logging.
3508
3509
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003510option dontlognull
3511no option dontlognull
3512 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3514 yes | yes | yes | no
3515 Arguments : none
3516
3517 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3518 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3519 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3520 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3521 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3522 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3523 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3524
3525 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3526 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3527 would not be logged.
3528
3529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003532 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003533
3534
3535option forceclose
3536no option forceclose
3537 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003539 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3543 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3544 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3545 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3546 global session times in the logs.
3547
3548 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003549 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003550 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3551 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3552 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3553 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003554
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003555 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3556 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3557 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3558
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003559 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3560 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3561
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003562 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003563
3564
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003565option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003566 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | yes
3569 Arguments :
3570 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3571 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003572 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003573 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003574
3575 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3576 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3577 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3578 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3579 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3580 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3581 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003582 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3583 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3584 possible that the client has already brought one.
3585
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003586 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003587 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003588 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3589 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003590 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3591 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003592
3593 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3594 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3595 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3596 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3597 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3598 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3599 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3600
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003601 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3602 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3603 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3604 are under the control of the end-user.
3605
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003606 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003607 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3608 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003609 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3610 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3611 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003612
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003613 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3614 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3615 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3616 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3617 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003618
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003619 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003620 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3621 frontend www
3622 mode http
3623 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3624
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003625 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3626 backend www
3627 mode http
3628 option forwardfor header X-Client
3629
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003630 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3631 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003632
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003633
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003634option http-no-delay
3635no option http-no-delay
3636 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3638 yes | yes | yes | yes
3639 Arguments : none
3640
3641 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3642 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3643 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3644 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3645 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3646 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3647 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3648 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3649 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3650 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3651 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3652 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3653 affected.
3654
3655 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3656 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3657 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3658 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3659 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3660 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3661 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3662 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3663 latency environments.
3664
3665
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003666option http-pretend-keepalive
3667no option http-pretend-keepalive
3668 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 yes | yes | yes | yes
3671 Arguments : none
3672
3673 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3674 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3675 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3676 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3677 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3678 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3679 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3680 consider the response complete.
3681
3682 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3683 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3684 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3685 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3686 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3687 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3688
3689 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3690 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3691 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3692 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3693 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3694 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3695 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3696
3697 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3698 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003699 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003700 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3701 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003702
3703 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3704 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3705
3706 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3707
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003708
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003709option http-server-close
3710no option http-server-close
3711 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3713 yes | yes | yes | yes
3714 Arguments : none
3715
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003716 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3717 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3718 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3719 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3720 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3721 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3722 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3723 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3724 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3725 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3726 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3727 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003728
3729 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3730 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3731 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3732 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003733 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3734 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003735
3736 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3737 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003738 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3739 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3740 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003741
3742 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3743 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3744
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003745 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3746 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003747
3748
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003749option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003750no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003751 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3753 yes | yes | yes | no
3754 Arguments : none
3755
3756 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3757 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3758 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3759 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3760 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3761 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3762 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3763
3764 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3765 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3766 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3767 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3768 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3769 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3770 request along its whole life.
3771
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003772 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3773 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3774 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3775 front of an existing proxy.
3776
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003777 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3778
3779 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3780 http-server-close".
3781
3782
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003783option httpchk
3784option httpchk <uri>
3785option httpchk <method> <uri>
3786option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3787 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3789 yes | no | yes | yes
3790 Arguments :
3791 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3792 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3793 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3794 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3795 ones.
3796
3797 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3798 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3799 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3800
3801 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3802 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3803 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3804 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3805 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3806
3807 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3808 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3809 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3810 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3811 the lack of any response.
3812
3813 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3814
3815 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3816 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3817 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3818
3819 Examples :
3820 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3821 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3822 backend https_relay
3823 mode tcp
3824 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3825 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3826
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09003827 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3828 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3829 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003830
3831
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003832option httpclose
3833no option httpclose
3834 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 yes | yes | yes | yes
3837 Arguments : none
3838
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003839 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3840 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3841 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3842 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3843 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3844 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3845 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003846
3847 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003848 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003849 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3850 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3851 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3852 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3853 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003854
3855 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3856 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3857 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003858 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3859 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003860
3861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3863
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003864 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3865 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003866
3867
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003868option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003869 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003872 Arguments :
3873 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3874 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3875 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3876 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3877 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003878
3879 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3880 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3881 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3882 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3883 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3884 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3885 ports.
3886
3887 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3888
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3891 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3892 by default.
3893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003894 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003895
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003896
3897option http_proxy
3898no option http_proxy
3899 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3901 yes | yes | yes | yes
3902 Arguments : none
3903
3904 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3905 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3906 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3907 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3908 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3909
3910 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3911 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3912 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3913 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003914 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003915 be analyzed.
3916
3917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3919
3920 Example :
3921 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3922 backend direct_forward
3923 option httpclose
3924 option http_proxy
3925
3926 See also : "option httpclose"
3927
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003928
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003929option independent-streams
3930no option independent-streams
3931 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3933 yes | yes | yes | yes
3934 Arguments : none
3935
3936 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3937 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3938 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3939 receive data or not.
3940
3941 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3942 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3943 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3944 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3945 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3946 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3947 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3948 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3949 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3950 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3951 socket buffers.
3952
3953 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3954 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3955 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3956 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3957 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3958
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003959 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3960 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3961 deprecated.
3962
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003963 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003964
3965
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003966option ldap-check
3967 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3969 yes | no | yes | yes
3970 Arguments : none
3971
3972 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3973 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3974 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3975 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3976
3977 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3978 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3979
3980 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3981 configure it.
3982
3983 Example :
3984 option ldap-check
3985
3986 See also : "option httpchk"
3987
3988
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003989option log-health-checks
3990no option log-health-checks
3991 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3993 yes | no | yes | yes
3994 Arguments : none
3995
3996 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3997 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3998 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3999 of additional information is limited.
4000
4001 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4002 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4003
4004 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4005
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004006
4007option log-separate-errors
4008no option log-separate-errors
4009 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | yes | yes | no
4012 Arguments : none
4013
4014 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4015 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4016 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4017 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4018 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4019 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4020 provides very important information.
4021
4022 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4023 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4024 error logs.
4025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004026 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004027 logging.
4028
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004029
4030option logasap
4031no option logasap
4032 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | yes | yes | no
4035 Arguments : none
4036
4037 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4038 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4039 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4040 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4041 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4042 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4043 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004044 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004045 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4046 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4047
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004048 Examples :
4049 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4050 mode http
4051 option httplog
4052 option logasap
4053 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4054
4055 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4056 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4057 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4058 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004060 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004061 logging.
4062
4063
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004064option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4065 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4067 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004068 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004069 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4070 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004071
4072 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4073 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4074 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4075 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4076 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4077 in the MySQL table, like this :
4078
4079 USE mysql;
4080 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4081 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4082
4083 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4084 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4085 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4086 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4087 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4088 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4089 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4090 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4091 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4092
4093 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4094 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004095
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004096 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004097
4098 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4099 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4100 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4101 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4102 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4103 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4104
4105 See also: "option httpchk"
4106
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004107option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4108 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4110 yes | no | yes | yes
4111 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004112 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4113 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004114
4115 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4116 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4117 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4118 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4119
4120 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004121
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004122option nolinger
4123no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004124 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004127 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004128
4129 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4130 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4131 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4132 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4133 connections.
4134
4135 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4136 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4137 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4138 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4139 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4140 this too.
4141
4142 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4143 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4144 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4145
4146 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4147 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4148 for servers.
4149
4150 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4151 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4152
4153
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004154option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4155 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4157 yes | yes | yes | yes
4158 Arguments :
4159 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4160 matching <network>
4161 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4162 header name.
4163
4164 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4165 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4166 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4167 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4168 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4169 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4170 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4171 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4172 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4173 possible that the client has already brought one.
4174
4175 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4176 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4177 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4178 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4179 header and requires different one.
4180
4181 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4182 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4183 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4184 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4185 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4186 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4187 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4188
4189 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4190 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4191 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4192 both are defined.
4193
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004194 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4195 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4196 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4197 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4198 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004199
4200 Examples :
4201 # Original Destination address
4202 frontend www
4203 mode http
4204 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4205
4206 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4207 backend www
4208 mode http
4209 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4210
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004211 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4212 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004213
4214
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004215option persist
4216no option persist
4217 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004220 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004221
4222 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4223 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4224 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4225 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4226 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4227 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4228 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4229 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4230 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4231 redirected to another valid server.
4232
4233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4235
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004236 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004237
4238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004239option redispatch
4240no option redispatch
4241 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4243 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004244 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004245
4246 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4247 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4248 be able to access the service anymore.
4249
4250 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4251 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4252
4253 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4254 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4255 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004257 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4258 "redisp" keywords.
4259
4260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4262
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004263 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004264
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004265
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004266option redis-check
4267 Use redis health checks for server testing
4268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4269 yes | no | yes | yes
4270 Arguments : none
4271
4272 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4273 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4274 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4275 find the "+PONG" response message.
4276
4277 Example :
4278 option redis-check
4279
4280 See also : "option httpchk"
4281
4282
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004283option smtpchk
4284option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4285 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4287 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004288 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004289 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4290 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4291 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4292
4293 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4294 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4295 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4296
4297 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4298 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4299 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4300 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4301 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4302 dead server.
4303
4304 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4305 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4306 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4307 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4308
4309 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4310 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4311 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4312 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4313 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4314
4315 Example :
4316 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4317
4318 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004321option socket-stats
4322no option socket-stats
4323
4324 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4326 yes | yes | yes | no
4327
4328 Arguments : none
4329
4330
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004331option splice-auto
4332no option splice-auto
4333 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4335 yes | yes | yes | yes
4336 Arguments : none
4337
4338 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4339 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4340 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4341 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004342 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004343 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4344 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4345 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4346 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4347
4348 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4349 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4350 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4351 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4352 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4353 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4354 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4355 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4356 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4357 keyword.
4358
4359 Example :
4360 option splice-auto
4361
4362 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4363 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4364
4365 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4366 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4367
4368
4369option splice-request
4370no option splice-request
4371 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 yes | yes | yes | yes
4374 Arguments : none
4375
4376 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004377 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004378 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4379 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4380 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4381 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4382
4383 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4384
4385 Example :
4386 option splice-request
4387
4388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4390
4391 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4392 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4393
4394
4395option splice-response
4396no option splice-response
4397 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | yes | yes | yes
4400 Arguments : none
4401
4402 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004403 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004404 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4405 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4406 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4407 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4408
4409 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4410
4411 Example :
4412 option splice-response
4413
4414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4416
4417 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4418 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4419
4420
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004421option srvtcpka
4422no option srvtcpka
4423 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4425 yes | no | yes | yes
4426 Arguments : none
4427
4428 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4429 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4430 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4431 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4432
4433 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4434 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4435 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4436 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4437
4438 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4439 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4440 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4441 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4442 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4443
4444 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4445
4446 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4447 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4448 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4449
4450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4452
4453 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4454
4455
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004456option ssl-hello-chk
4457 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4459 yes | no | yes | yes
4460 Arguments : none
4461
4462 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4463 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4464 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4465 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4466 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4467 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4468 hello message.
4469
4470 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4471 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4472 messages, which is appreciable.
4473
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004474 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4475 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4476 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004477
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004478 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4479
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004480
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004481option tcp-smart-accept
4482no option tcp-smart-accept
4483 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4485 yes | yes | yes | no
4486 Arguments : none
4487
4488 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4489 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4490 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4491 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4492 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4493 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4494
4495 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4496 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4497 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4498 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4499
4500 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4501 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4502 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4503 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4504
4505 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4506 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4507 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4508
4509 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4510 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4511 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4512
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004513 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4514
4515
4516option tcp-smart-connect
4517no option tcp-smart-connect
4518 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4520 yes | no | yes | yes
4521 Arguments : none
4522
4523 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4524 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4525 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4526 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4527 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4528
4529 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4530 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4531 complex.
4532
4533 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4534 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4535 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4536
4537 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4538 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4539
4540 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4541
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004542
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004543option tcpka
4544 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4546 yes | yes | yes | yes
4547 Arguments : none
4548
4549 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4550 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4551 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4552 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4553
4554 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4555 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4556 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4557 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4558
4559 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4560 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4561 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4562 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4563 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4564
4565 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4566
4567 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4568 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4569 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4570 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4571 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4572 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4573 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4574 backends.
4575
4576 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4577
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004578
4579option tcplog
4580 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 yes | yes | yes | yes
4583 Arguments : none
4584
4585 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4586 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4587 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4588 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4589 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4590 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4591 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4592 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4593
4594 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004596 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004597
4598
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004599option transparent
4600no option transparent
4601 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004603 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004604 Arguments : none
4605
4606 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4607 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4608 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4609 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4610 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4611 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4612 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4613 appropriate server.
4614
4615 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4616 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4617
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004618 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004619 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004620
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004621
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004622persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004623persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004624 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4626 yes | no | yes | yes
4627 Arguments :
4628 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004629 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4630 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004631
4632 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4633 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4634 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4635 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4636 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4637 forwarded to this server.
4638
4639 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4640 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4641 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004642 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004643 a single "listen" section.
4644
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004645 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4646 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4647 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4648
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004649 Example :
4650 listen tse-farm
4651 bind :3389
4652 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4653 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4654 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4655 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4656 persist rdp-cookie
4657 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004658 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004659 balance rdp-cookie
4660 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4661 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4662
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004663 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4664 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004665
4666
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004667rate-limit sessions <rate>
4668 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 yes | yes | yes | no
4671 Arguments :
4672 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4673 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4674
4675 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4676 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4677 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4678 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4679 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4680 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4681
4682 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4683 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4684 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4685 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4686
4687 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4688 listen smtp
4689 mode tcp
4690 bind :25
4691 rate-limit sessions 10
4692 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4693
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004694 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4695 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4696 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004697
4698 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4699
4700
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004701redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4702redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4703redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004704 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 no | yes | yes | yes
4707
4708 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004709 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004710
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004711 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004712 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004713 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
4714 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
4715 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004716
4717 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4718 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4719 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4720 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4721 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004722 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
4723 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
4724 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
4725 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004726
4727 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4728 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4729 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4730 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4731 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4732 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4733 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4734 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004735 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
4736 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
4737 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004738
4739 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01004740 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
4741 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
4742 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
4743 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
4744 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
4745 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
4746 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
4747 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004748
4749 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4750 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4751
4752 - "drop-query"
4753 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4754 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4755 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4756 with a location-type redirect.
4757
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004758 - "append-slash"
4759 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4760 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4761 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4762 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4763
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004764 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4765 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4766 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4767 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4768 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4769 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4770 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4771
4772 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4773 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4774 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4775 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4776 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4777 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4778 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004779
4780 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4781 acl clear dst_port 80
4782 acl secure dst_port 8080
4783 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004784 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004785 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004786 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4787
4788 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004789 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4790 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4791 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004792 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004793
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004794 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4795 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4796 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4797
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004798 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004799 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004800
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004801 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
4802 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
4803 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
4804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004805 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004806
4807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004808redisp (deprecated)
4809redispatch (deprecated)
4810 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004813 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004814
4815 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4816 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4817 be able to access the service anymore.
4818
4819 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4820 redistribute them to a working server.
4821
4822 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4823 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4824 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004826 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4827 "option redispatch" instead.
4828
4829 See also : "option redispatch"
4830
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004831
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004832reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004833 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4835 no | yes | yes | yes
4836 Arguments :
4837 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4838 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004839 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004840
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004841 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4842 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4843
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004844 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4845 the last header of an HTTP request.
4846
4847 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4848 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4849 responses.
4850
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004851 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4852 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4853 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4854
4855 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4856 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004857
4858
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004859reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4860reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004861 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 no | yes | yes | yes
4864 Arguments :
4865 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4866 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4867 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4868 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4869 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4870 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4871 ignores case.
4872
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004873 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4874 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4875
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004876 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4877 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4878 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4879 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004880 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004881
4882 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4883 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4884
4885 Example :
4886 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4887 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4888 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4889
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004890 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4891 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004892
4893
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004894reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4895reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004896 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 no | yes | yes | yes
4899 Arguments :
4900 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4901 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4902 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4903 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4904 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4905 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4906
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004907 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4908 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4909
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004910 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4911 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4912 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4913 next servers.
4914
4915 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4916 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4917 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4918
4919 Example :
4920 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4921 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4922 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4923
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004924 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4925 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004926
4927
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004928reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4929reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004930 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4932 no | yes | yes | yes
4933 Arguments :
4934 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4935 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4936 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4937 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4938 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4939 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4940 case.
4941
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004942 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4943 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4944
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004945 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4946 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4947 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4948 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004949 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004950
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004951 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004952 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004953 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004954
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004955 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4956 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4957
4958 Example :
4959 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4960 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4961 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4962
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004963 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4964 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004965
4966
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004967reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4968reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004969 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 no | yes | yes | yes
4972 Arguments :
4973 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4974 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4975 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4976 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4977 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4978 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4979 case.
4980
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004981 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4982 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4983
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004984 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4985 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4986 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4987 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4988
4989 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4990 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4991
4992 Example :
4993 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4994 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4995 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4996 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4997
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004998 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4999 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005000
5001
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005002reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5003reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005004 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 no | yes | yes | yes
5007 Arguments :
5008 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5009 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5010 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5011 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5012 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5013 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5014
5015 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5016 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5017 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5018 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005019 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005020
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005021 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5022 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5023
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005024 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5025 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5026 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5027
5028 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5029 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5030 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5031 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5032 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5033
5034 Example :
5035 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005036 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005037 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5038 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5039
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005040 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5041 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005042
5043
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005044reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5045reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005046 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 no | yes | yes | yes
5049 Arguments :
5050 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5051 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5052 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5053 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5054 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5055 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5056 ignores case.
5057
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005058 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5059 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5060
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005061 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5062 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005063 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5064 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5065 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005066 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5067 not set.
5068
5069 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5070 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5071 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5072 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5073 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5074
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005075 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005076 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5077 # block all others.
5078 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5079 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5080
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005081 # block bad guys
5082 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5083 reqitarpit . if badguys
5084
5085 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5086 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005087
5088
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005089retries <value>
5090 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5092 yes | no | yes | yes
5093 Arguments :
5094 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5095 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5096 default value is 3.
5097
5098 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5099 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5100 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5101
5102 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5103 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5104
5105 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5106 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5107
5108 See also : "option redispatch"
5109
5110
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005111rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005112 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 no | yes | yes | yes
5115 Arguments :
5116 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5117 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005118 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005119
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005120 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5121 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5122
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005123 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5124 the last header of an HTTP response.
5125
5126 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5127 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5128 responses.
5129
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005130 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5131 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005132
5133
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005134rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5135rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005136 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 no | yes | yes | yes
5139 Arguments :
5140 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5141 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5142 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5143 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5144 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5145 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5146 ignores case.
5147
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005148 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5149 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5150
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005151 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5152 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005153 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005154 client.
5155
5156 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5157 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5158 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5159
5160 Example :
5161 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005162 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005163
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005164 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5165 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005166
5167
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005168rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5169rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005170 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5172 no | yes | yes | yes
5173 Arguments :
5174 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5175 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5176 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5177 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5178 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5179 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5180 ignores case.
5181
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005182 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5183 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5184
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005185 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5186 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5187 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5188 case-sensitive.
5189
5190 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005191 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5192 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5193 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005194
5195 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5196 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5197
5198 Example :
5199 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5200 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5201
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005202 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5203 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005204
5205
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005206rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5207rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005208 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 no | yes | yes | yes
5211 Arguments :
5212 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5213 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5214 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5215 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5216 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5217 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5218 ignores case.
5219
5220 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5221 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5222 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5223 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005224 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005225
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005226 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5227 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5228
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005229 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5230 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5231 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5232
5233 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5234 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5235 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5236 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5237 are not case-sensitive.
5238
5239 Example :
5240 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5241 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5242
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005243 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5244 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005245
5246
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005247server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005248 Declare a server in a backend
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5250 no | no | yes | yes
5251 Arguments :
5252 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005253 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005254 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005255
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005256 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5257 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5258 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5259 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005260 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5261 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5262 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5263 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5264 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005265 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5266 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5267 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5268 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5269 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5270 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5271 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005272 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5273 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5274 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5275 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005276
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005277 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005278 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5279 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5280 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5281 adding this value to the client's port.
5282
5283 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5284 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005285 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005286
5287 Examples :
5288 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5289 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005290 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005291 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5292 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5293 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005294
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005295 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5296 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005297
5298
5299source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005300source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005301source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005302 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | no | yes | yes
5305 Arguments :
5306 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5307 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005308
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005309 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005310 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5311 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5312 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5313 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5314 supported prefixes are :
5315 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5316 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5317 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005318 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5319 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5320 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5321 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005322
5323 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5324 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005325 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5326 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5327 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005328
5329 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5330 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5331 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5332 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5333 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5334 <addr>.
5335
5336 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5337 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5338 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5339 port.
5340
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005341 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5342 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5343 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5344 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005345 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005346 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5347 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5348 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5349 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5350 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5351 HTTP header.
5352
5353 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5354 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005355 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005356 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5357 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5358 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5359 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5360 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5361 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5362 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5363
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005364 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5365 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5366 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5367 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5368 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5369 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5370
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005371 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5372 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5373 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5374 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5375
5376 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5377 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5378 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5379 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5380 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5381 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5382
5383 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5384 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5385 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5386 there are two methods :
5387
5388 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5389 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5390 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5391 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5392 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5393 of the client ranges may be used.
5394
5395 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5396 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5397 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5398 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5399 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5400 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5401 same session.
5402
5403 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5404 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5405 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5406 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5407 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5408 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5409
5410 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5411 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5412 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005413 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005414
5415 Examples :
5416 backend private
5417 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5418 source 192.168.1.200
5419
5420 backend transparent_ssl1
5421 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5422 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5423
5424 backend transparent_ssl2
5425 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5426 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5427 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5428
5429 backend transparent_ssl3
5430 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5431 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5432 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5433
5434 backend transparent_smtp
5435 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5436 # with Tproxy version 4.
5437 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5438
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005439 backend transparent_http
5440 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5441 # proxy.
5442 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005444 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005445 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005447
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005448srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5449 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5451 yes | no | yes | yes
5452 Arguments :
5453 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5454 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5455 as explained at the top of this document.
5456
5457 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5458 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5459 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5460 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5461 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5462 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5463 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5464
5465 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5466 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5467 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5468 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5469 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005470 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005471 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005472 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005473
5474 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5475 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5476 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5477 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5478 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5479 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5480
5481 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5482 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5483
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005484 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5485 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005486
5487
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005488stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5489 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5491 no | no | yes | yes
5492
5493 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5494 matched.
5495
5496 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5497 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5498
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005499 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5500 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5501 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5502
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005503 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5504 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5505 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5506 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005507
5508 Example :
5509 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5510 backend stats_localhost
5511 stats enable
5512 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5513
5514 Example :
5515 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5516 backend stats_auth
5517 stats enable
5518 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5519 stats admin if TRUE
5520
5521 Example :
5522 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5523 userlist stats-auth
5524 group admin users admin
5525 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5526 group readonly users haproxy
5527 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5528
5529 backend stats_auth
5530 stats enable
5531 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5532 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5533 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5534 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5535
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005536 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5537 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5538 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005539
5540
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005541stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5542 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5544 yes | no | yes | yes
5545 Arguments :
5546 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5547
5548 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5549
5550 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5551 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5552 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5553 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5554 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5555 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5556
5557 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5558 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5559 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005560 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005561
5562 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5563 report using "stats scope".
5564
5565 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5566 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5567 unobvious parameters.
5568
5569 Example :
5570 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5571 backend public_www
5572 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5573 stats enable
5574 stats hide-version
5575 stats scope .
5576 stats uri /admin?stats
5577 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5578 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5579 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5580
5581 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5582 backend private_monitoring
5583 stats enable
5584 stats uri /admin?stats
5585 stats refresh 5s
5586
5587 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5588
5589
5590stats enable
5591 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5593 yes | no | yes | yes
5594 Arguments : none
5595
5596 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5597 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5598 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5599 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5600 - stats auth : no authentication
5601 - stats scope : no restriction
5602
5603 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5604 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5605 unobvious parameters.
5606
5607 Example :
5608 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5609 backend public_www
5610 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5611 stats enable
5612 stats hide-version
5613 stats scope .
5614 stats uri /admin?stats
5615 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5616 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5617 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5618
5619 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5620 backend private_monitoring
5621 stats enable
5622 stats uri /admin?stats
5623 stats refresh 5s
5624
5625 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5626
5627
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005628stats hide-version
5629 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5631 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005632 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005633
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005634 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5635 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5636 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5637 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5638 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5639 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005641 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5642 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5643 unobvious parameters.
5644
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005645 Example :
5646 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5647 backend public_www
5648 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005649 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005650 stats hide-version
5651 stats scope .
5652 stats uri /admin?stats
5653 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5654 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5655 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005656
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005657 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5658 backend private_monitoring
5659 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005660 stats uri /admin?stats
5661 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005663 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005664
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005665
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005666stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5667 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5668 Access control for statistics
5669
5670 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5671 no | no | yes | yes
5672
5673 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5674 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5675 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5676 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5677 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5678 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5679
5680 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5681 instance.
5682
5683 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5684 about ACL usage.
5685
5686
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005687stats realm <realm>
5688 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 yes | no | yes | yes
5691 Arguments :
5692 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5693 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5694 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5695
5696 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5697 using a backslash ('\').
5698
5699 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5700 only related to authentication.
5701
5702 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5703 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5704 unobvious parameters.
5705
5706 Example :
5707 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5708 backend public_www
5709 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5710 stats enable
5711 stats hide-version
5712 stats scope .
5713 stats uri /admin?stats
5714 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5715 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5716 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5717
5718 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5719 backend private_monitoring
5720 stats enable
5721 stats uri /admin?stats
5722 stats refresh 5s
5723
5724 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5725
5726
5727stats refresh <delay>
5728 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 yes | no | yes | yes
5731 Arguments :
5732 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5733 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5734 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5735 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5736 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5737 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5738
5739 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5740 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5741 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5742 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5743
5744 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5745 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5746 unobvious parameters.
5747
5748 Example :
5749 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5750 backend public_www
5751 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5752 stats enable
5753 stats hide-version
5754 stats scope .
5755 stats uri /admin?stats
5756 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5757 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5758 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5759
5760 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5761 backend private_monitoring
5762 stats enable
5763 stats uri /admin?stats
5764 stats refresh 5s
5765
5766 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5767
5768
5769stats scope { <name> | "." }
5770 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5772 yes | no | yes | yes
5773 Arguments :
5774 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5775 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5776 section in which the statement appears.
5777
5778 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5779 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5780 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5781 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5782 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5783 exists.
5784
5785 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5786 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5787 unobvious parameters.
5788
5789 Example :
5790 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5791 backend public_www
5792 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5793 stats enable
5794 stats hide-version
5795 stats scope .
5796 stats uri /admin?stats
5797 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5798 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5799 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5800
5801 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5802 backend private_monitoring
5803 stats enable
5804 stats uri /admin?stats
5805 stats refresh 5s
5806
5807 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5808
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005809
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005810stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005811 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5813 yes | no | yes | yes
5814
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005815 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005816 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5817
5818 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5819 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5820
5821 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5822 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005823 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005824
5825 Example :
5826 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5827 backend private_monitoring
5828 stats enable
5829 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5830 stats uri /admin?stats
5831 stats refresh 5s
5832
5833 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5834 global section.
5835
5836
5837stats show-legends
5838 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5839 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5840 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5841 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5842 - IP (socket, server)
5843 - cookie (backend, server)
5844
5845 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5846 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005847 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005848
5849 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5850
5851
5852stats show-node [ <name> ]
5853 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5855 yes | no | yes | yes
5856 Arguments:
5857 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5858 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5859
5860 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5861 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005862 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005863
5864 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5865 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5866 unobvious parameters.
5867
5868 Example:
5869 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5870 backend private_monitoring
5871 stats enable
5872 stats show-node Europe-1
5873 stats uri /admin?stats
5874 stats refresh 5s
5875
5876 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5877 section.
5878
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005879
5880stats uri <prefix>
5881 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 yes | no | yes | yes
5884 Arguments :
5885 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5886 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5887 query string.
5888
5889 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5890 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5891 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5892 possible to reach it in the application.
5893
5894 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005895 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005896 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5897 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5898 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5899 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5900
5901 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5902 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5903 an address or a port to statistics only.
5904
5905 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5906 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5907 unobvious parameters.
5908
5909 Example :
5910 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5911 backend public_www
5912 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5913 stats enable
5914 stats hide-version
5915 stats scope .
5916 stats uri /admin?stats
5917 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5918 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5919 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5920
5921 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5922 backend private_monitoring
5923 stats enable
5924 stats uri /admin?stats
5925 stats refresh 5s
5926
5927 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5928
5929
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005930stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5931 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005933 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005934
5935 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02005936 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005937 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5938 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5939 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5940
5941 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5942 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5943 the "stick-table" statement.
5944
5945 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5946 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5947 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5948 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5949 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5950
5951 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5952 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5953 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5954 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5955 transformation rules.
5956
5957 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5958 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5959 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5960 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5961 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5962 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5963 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5964
5965 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5966 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5967 ACL based conditions.
5968
5969 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5970 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5971 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5972 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5973
5974 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5975 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5976 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5977 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5978
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005979 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5980 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5981 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5982
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005983 Example :
5984 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5985 # last 30 minutes
5986 backend pop
5987 mode tcp
5988 balance roundrobin
5989 stick store-request src
5990 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5991 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5992 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5993
5994 backend smtp
5995 mode tcp
5996 balance roundrobin
5997 stick match src table pop
5998 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5999 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6000
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006001 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6002 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006003
6004
6005stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6006 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 no | no | yes | yes
6009
6010 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6011 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6012 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6013 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6014
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006015 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6016 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6017 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6018
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006019 Examples :
6020 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006021 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006022
6023 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6024 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6025 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6026
6027
6028 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6029 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6030 backend http
6031 mode http
6032 balance roundrobin
6033 stick on src table https
6034 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6035 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6036 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6037
6038 backend https
6039 mode tcp
6040 balance roundrobin
6041 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6042 stick on src
6043 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6044 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6045
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006046 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006047
6048
6049stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6050 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 no | no | yes | yes
6053
6054 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006055 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006056 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6057 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6058 server is selected.
6059
6060 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6061 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6062 the "stick-table" statement.
6063
6064 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6065 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6066 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6067 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6068 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6069 address.
6070
6071 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6072 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6073 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6074 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6075 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6076 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6077 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6078 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6079 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6080 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6081
6082 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6083 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6084 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6085 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6086 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6087 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6088 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6089
6090 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6091 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6092 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6093 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6094
6095 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6096 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6097 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6098 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6099 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6100 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6101 another protocol or access method.
6102
6103 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6104 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6105 the request.
6106
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006107 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6108 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6109 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6110
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006111 Example :
6112 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6113 # last 30 minutes
6114 backend pop
6115 mode tcp
6116 balance roundrobin
6117 stick store-request src
6118 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6119 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6120 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6121
6122 backend smtp
6123 mode tcp
6124 balance roundrobin
6125 stick match src table pop
6126 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6127 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6128
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006129 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6130 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006131
6132
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006133stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006134 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6135 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006136 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006138 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006139
6140 Arguments :
6141 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6142 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6143 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6144 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6145
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006146 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6147 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6148 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6149 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6150
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006151 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6152 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6153 instance.
6154
6155 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6156 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6157 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6158 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6159 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6160 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006161 to 32 characters.
6162
6163 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6164 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6165 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6166 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6167 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6168 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006169
6170 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006171 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6172 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006173 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6174 increase.
6175
6176 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006177 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6178 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6179 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006180
6181 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6182 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6183 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6184 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6185 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6186 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6187 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6188 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6189 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6190 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6191 parameter (see below).
6192
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006193 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6194 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6195 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6196 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6197 soft restart.
6198
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006199 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6200
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006201 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6202 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6203 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6204 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6205 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006206 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006207 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6208 if not expiration delay is specified.
6209
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006210 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6211 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6212 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6213 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006214 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6215 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6216 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6217 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6218 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6219 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6220 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6221 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6222 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6223 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6224 types and their arguments.
6225
6226 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6227 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6228 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6229 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6230
6231 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6232 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6233 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6234 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6235
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006236 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6237 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6238 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6239 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6240 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6241 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6242
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006243 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6244 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6245 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6246 they were received.
6247
6248 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6249 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6250 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6251 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6252 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6253
6254 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6255 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6256 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6257 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6258 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6259
6260 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6261 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6262 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6263
6264 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6265 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6266 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6267 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6268 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6269
6270 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6271 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6272 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6273 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6274 the client side.
6275
6276 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6277 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6278 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6279 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6280 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6281 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6282 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6283
6284 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6285 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6286 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6287 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6288 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6289 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6290 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6291
6292 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6293 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6294 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6295 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6296 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6297 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6298
6299 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6300 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6301 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6302 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6303
6304 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6305 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6306 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6307 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6308 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6309 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6310 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6311 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6312 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6313 recommended for better fairness.
6314
6315 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6316 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6317 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6318 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6319
6320 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6321 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6322 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6323 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6324 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6325 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6326 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6327 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6328 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6329 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006330
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006331 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6332 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006333 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6334 reference it.
6335
6336 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6337 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6338 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6339 as an exclusive stickiness.
6340
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006341 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6342 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6343 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6344 something that can be ignored.
6345
6346 Example:
6347 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6348 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6349 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6350 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6351
6352 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006353 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006354
6355
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006356stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6357 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6359 no | no | yes | yes
6360
6361 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006362 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006363 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6364 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6365 server is selected.
6366
6367 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6368 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6369 the "stick-table" statement.
6370
6371 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6372 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6373 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6374 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6375
6376 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6377 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6378 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6379 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6380 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6381 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006382 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006383 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6384 rules.
6385
6386 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6387 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6388 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6389 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6390 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6391 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6392 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6393
6394 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6395 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6396 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6397 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6398
6399 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6400 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6401 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6402 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6403 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6404 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6405 another protocol or access method.
6406
6407 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6408
6409 Example :
6410 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6411 backend https
6412 mode tcp
6413 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006414 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006415 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006416
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006417 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6418 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6419
6420 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6421 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6422 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6423
6424 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6425 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006426
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006427 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6428 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6429 # at offset 44.
6430
6431 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6432 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6433
6434 # Learn on response if server hello.
6435 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006436
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006437 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6438 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6439
6440 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6441 extraction.
6442
6443
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006444tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6445 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006448 Arguments :
6449 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006450 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6451 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006453 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006454
6455 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6456 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006457 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6458 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6459 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6460 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6461 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6462 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006463
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006464 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6465 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6466 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6467 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006468
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006469 Three types of actions are supported :
6470 - accept :
6471 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6472 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6473 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006475 - reject :
6476 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6477 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6478 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6479 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6480 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6481 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6482 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6483 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6484 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6485 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6486 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6487 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006488
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006489 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6490 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6491 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6492 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6493 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6494 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6495 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6496 hosts.
6497
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006498 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006499 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6500 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6501 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006502 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6503 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006504 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006505 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6506 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6507 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6508 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6509 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006511 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006512 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006513 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006514 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6515 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6516 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6517 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006519 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6520 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6521 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6522 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006524 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6525 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6526 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6527 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6528 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006529 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6530 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6531 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6532 layer7 information is extracted.
6533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006534 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6535 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6536 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6537 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6538 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006540 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6541 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6542 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006544 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6545 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6546 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006547
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006548 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006549 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006550 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006551
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006552 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6553 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6554 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006555
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006556 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006557 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6558 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006559
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006560 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6561
6562 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6563
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006564 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006566 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006567
6568
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006569tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6570 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006572 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006573 Arguments :
6574 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006575 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6576 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006577 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006579 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006581 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6582 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6583 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6584 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6585 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006586
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006587 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6588 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6589 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6590 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6591 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6592 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6593 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6594 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6595 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006596
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006597 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6598 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6599 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6600 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006602 Three types of actions are supported :
6603 - accept :
6604 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006605 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006607 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6608 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006609
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006610 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6611 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6612 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006613 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6614 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6615 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6616 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006617 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6618 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006619 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006621 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006622 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6623 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006625 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006626 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6627 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6628 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6629 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6630 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006631
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006632 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6633 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6634 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6635 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6636
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006637 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006638 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6639 # and reject everything else.
6640 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6641 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006642 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006643 tcp-request content reject
6644
6645 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006646 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6647 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6648 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006649 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006650
6651 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6652 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6653 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006654 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006655 tcp-request content reject
6656
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006657 Example:
6658 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6659 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006660 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006661
6662 Example:
6663 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6664 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006665 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006666
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006667 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6668 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6669
6670 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006671 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006672 # protecting all our sites
6673 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006674 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6675 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006676 ...
6677 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6678
6679 backend http_dynamic
6680 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006681 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006682 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006683 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6684 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6685 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006686 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006688 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006690 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006691
6692
6693tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6694 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006696 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006697 Arguments :
6698 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6699 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6700 as explained at the top of this document.
6701
6702 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6703 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6704 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6705 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6706 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6707
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006708 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6709 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6710 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6711 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6712
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006713 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6714 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006715 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006716 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006717 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6718 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6719 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6720 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006721
6722 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6723 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6724 it pass through unaffected.
6725
6726 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6727 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6728 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006729 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006730 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6731 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006732 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6733 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6734 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006735
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006736 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006737 "timeout client".
6738
6739
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006740tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6741 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6743 no | no | yes | yes
6744 Arguments :
6745 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006746 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006747
6748 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6749
6750 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6751 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6752 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006753 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
6754 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006755
6756 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6757
6758 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6759 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6760 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6761 inserted.
6762
6763 Two types of actions are supported :
6764 - accept :
6765 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6766 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6767 the rules evaluation.
6768
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006769 - close :
6770 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
6771 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
6772 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
6773 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
6774 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
6775 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
6776 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
6777 protocols.
6778
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006779 - reject :
6780 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6781 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006782 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006783
6784 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6785 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6786 for changing the default action to a reject.
6787
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006788 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6789 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6790 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6791 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006792 period.
6793
6794 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6795
6796 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6797
6798
6799tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6800 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6802 no | no | yes | yes
6803 Arguments :
6804 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6805 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6806 as explained at the top of this document.
6807
6808 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6809
6810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006811timeout check <timeout>
6812 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6813 established.
6814
6815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6816 yes | no | yes | yes
6817 Arguments:
6818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6820 as explained at the top of this document.
6821
6822 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6823 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6824 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6825 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006826 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6827 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6828 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006829
6830 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6831 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6832
6833 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6834 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006835 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006836
6837 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6838 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6839 forget about it.
6840
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006841 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6842 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006843
6844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006845timeout client <timeout>
6846timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6847 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6849 yes | yes | yes | no
6850 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006851 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006852 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6853 as explained at the top of this document.
6854
6855 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6856 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6857 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6858 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6859 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6860 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6861 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6862 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006863 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006864 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006865 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6866 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6867 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006868
6869 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6870 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6871 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6872 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6873 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6874 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6875
6876 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6877 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6878 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6879
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006880 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006881
6882
6883timeout connect <timeout>
6884timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6885 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6887 yes | no | yes | yes
6888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006889 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006890 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6891 as explained at the top of this document.
6892
6893 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006894 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006895 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006896 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006897 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6898 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006899
6900 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6901 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6902 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6903 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6904 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6905 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6906
6907 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6908 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6909 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6910
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006911 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6912 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006913
6914
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006915timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6916 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | yes | yes | yes
6919 Arguments :
6920 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6921 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6922 as explained at the top of this document.
6923
6924 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6925 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6926 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6927 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6928 once the request has started to present itself.
6929
6930 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6931 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6932 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6933 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6934 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6935
6936 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6937 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6938 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6939 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6940
6941 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6942 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6943 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6944 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6945 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006946 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006947
6948 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6949 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6950 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6951 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6952
6953 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6954
6955
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006956timeout http-request <timeout>
6957 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006959 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006960 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006961 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006962 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6963 as explained at the top of this document.
6964
6965 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6966 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6967 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6968 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6969 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6970 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6971 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6972 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6973
6974 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6975 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006976 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6977 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006978
6979 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6980 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6981 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6982 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6983 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6984
6985 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006986 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6987 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6988 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006989
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006990 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006991
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006992
6993timeout queue <timeout>
6994 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6996 yes | no | yes | yes
6997 Arguments :
6998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7000 as explained at the top of this document.
7001
7002 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7003 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7004 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7005 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7006 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7007
7008 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7009 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7010 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7011 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7012
7013 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7014
7015
7016timeout server <timeout>
7017timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7018 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7020 yes | no | yes | yes
7021 Arguments :
7022 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7023 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7024 as explained at the top of this document.
7025
7026 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7027 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7028 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7029 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7030 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7031 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7032 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7033
7034 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7035 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7036 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7037 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7038 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007039 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007040 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007041 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7042 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7043 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7044 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007045
7046 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7047 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7048 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7049 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7050 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7051 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7052
7053 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7054 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7055 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7056
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007057 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007058
7059
7060timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007061 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7063 yes | yes | yes | yes
7064 Arguments :
7065 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7066 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7067 as explained at the top of this document.
7068
7069 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7070 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7071 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7072
7073 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7074 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7075 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7076 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007077 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007078
7079 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7080
7081
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007082timeout tunnel <timeout>
7083 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7085 yes | no | yes | yes
7086 Arguments :
7087 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7088 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7089 as explained at the top of this document.
7090
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007091 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007092 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7093 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7094 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7095 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7096 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7097 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7098 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7099 specified.
7100
7101 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7102 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7103 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7104 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7105 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7106
7107 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7108 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7109 forget about it.
7110
7111 Example :
7112 defaults http
7113 option http-server-close
7114 timeout connect 5s
7115 timeout client 30s
7116 timeout client 30s
7117 timeout server 30s
7118 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7119
7120 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7121
7122
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007123transparent (deprecated)
7124 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007126 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007127 Arguments : none
7128
7129 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7130 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7131 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7132 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7133 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7134 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7135 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7136 appropriate server.
7137
7138 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7139
7140 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7141 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7142
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007143 See also: "option transparent"
7144
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007145unique-id-format <string>
7146 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 yes | yes | yes | no
7149 Arguments :
7150 <string> is a log-format string.
7151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007152 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7153 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7154 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7155 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007156
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007157 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7158 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7159 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7160 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7161 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7162 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7163 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7164 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007165
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007166 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7167 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007168
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007169 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007170
7171 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7172
7173 will generate:
7174
7175 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7176
7177 See also: "unique-id-header"
7178
7179unique-id-header <name>
7180 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7182 yes | yes | yes | no
7183 Arguments :
7184 <name> is the name of the header.
7185
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007186 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7187 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007188
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007189 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007190
7191 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7192 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7193
7194 will generate:
7195
7196 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7197
7198 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007199
7200use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7201use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007202 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7204 no | yes | yes | no
7205 Arguments :
7206 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007208 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007209
7210 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7211 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7212 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007213 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7214 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7215 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7216 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007217
7218 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7219 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7220 assign the backend.
7221
7222 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7223 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7224 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7225 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7226 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7227 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7228
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007229 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007230 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007231 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7232 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7233 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7234
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007235 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007236
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007237
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007238use-server <server> if <condition>
7239use-server <server> unless <condition>
7240 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7242 no | no | yes | yes
7243 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007244 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007245
7246 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7247
7248 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7249 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7250 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7251
7252 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7253 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7254 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7255 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7256 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7257 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7258 matches will assign the server.
7259
7260 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7261 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7262 with the next rules until one matches.
7263
7264 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7265 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7266 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7267 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7268
7269 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7270 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7271 stripped.
7272
7273 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7274 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7275 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7276 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7277
7278 Example :
7279 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7280 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7281 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7282 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7283 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7284 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7285 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7286 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7287 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7288
7289 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7290
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007291
72925. Bind and Server options
7293--------------------------
7294
7295The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7296depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7297settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7298written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7299described in this section.
7300
7301
73025.1. Bind options
7303-----------------
7304
7305The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7306as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7307no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7308parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7309while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7310provided immediately after the setting name.
7311
7312The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7313
7314accept-proxy
7315 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7316 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7317 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7318 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7319 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7320 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7321 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7322 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7323 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007324 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7325 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007326
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007327alpn <protocols>
7328 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7329 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7330 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7331 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7332 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7333 initial NPN extension.
7334
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007335backlog <backlog>
7336 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7337 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7338
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007339ecdhe <named curve>
7340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007341 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7342 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007343
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007344ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7346 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7347 client's certificate.
7348
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007349ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7351 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7352 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7353 error is ignored.
7354
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007355ciphers <ciphers>
7356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7357 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7358 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7359 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7360 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7361
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007362crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7364 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7365 to verify client's certificate.
7366
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007367crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7369 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7370 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7371 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7372 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7373 file.
7374
7375 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7376 are loaded.
7377
7378 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7379 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7380 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7381 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7382 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7383 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7384 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7385 www.sub.example.org).
7386
7387 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7388 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7389 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7390 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7391 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7392
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007393 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007394
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007395 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7396 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7397 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7398 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7399 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7400 clients).
7401
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007402crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007403 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7404 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7405 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7406 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007407
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007408crt-list <file>
7409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007410 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7411 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007412
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007413 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007414
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007415 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7416 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7417 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7418 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7419 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7420 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7421 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7422 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007423
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007424defer-accept
7425 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7426 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7427 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7428 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7429 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7430 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7431 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7432 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7433 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7434 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7435 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7436
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007437force-sslv3
7438 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7439 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7440 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7441
7442force-tlsv10
7443 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7444 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7445
7446force-tlsv11
7447 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7448 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7449
7450force-tlsv12
7451 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7452 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7453
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007454gid <gid>
7455 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7456 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7457 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7458 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7459 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7460
7461group <group>
7462 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7463 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7464 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7465 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7466 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7467
7468id <id>
7469 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7470 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7471 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7472 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7473
7474interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007475 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7476 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7477 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7478 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7479 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7480 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7481 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007482
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007483level <level>
7484 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7485 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7486 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7487 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7488 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7489 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7490 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7491 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7492 counters).
7493 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7494 all counters).
7495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007496maxconn <maxconn>
7497 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7498 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7499 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7500 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7501 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7502 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7503 eat all memory.
7504
7505mode <mode>
7506 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7507 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7508 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7509 UNIX sockets.
7510
7511mss <maxseg>
7512 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7513 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7514 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7515 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7516 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7517 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7518 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7519 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7520 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7521 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7522 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7523
7524name <name>
7525 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7526 page.
7527
7528nice <nice>
7529 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7530 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7531 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7532 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7533 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7534 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7535 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7536 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7537 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7538 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7539 one for an RDP socket.
7540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007541no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7543 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7544 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007545 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7546 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007547
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007548no-tls-tickets
7549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7550 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7551 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7552 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7553
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007554no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007556 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7557 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7558 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7559 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007560
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007561no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007562 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007563 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7564 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7565 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7566 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007567
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007568no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007570 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7571 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7572 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7573 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007574
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007575npn <protocols>
7576 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7577 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7578 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7579 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007580 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7581 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007582
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007583ssl
7584 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7585 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7586 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7587 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7588 to deciphered contents.
7589
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007590strict-sni
7591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7592 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7593 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7594 See the "crt" option for more information.
7595
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007596tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007597 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007598 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7599 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7600 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7601 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7602 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7603 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7604 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007605 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7606 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7607 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007608
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007609transparent
7610 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7611 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7612 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7613 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7614 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7615 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7616 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7617 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7618 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7619 so check for support with your vendor.
7620
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007621v4v6
7622 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7623 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7624 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7625 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7626 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7627
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007628v6only
7629 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7630 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7631 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007632 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7633 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007634
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007635uid <uid>
7636 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7637 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7638 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7639 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7640 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7641
7642user <user>
7643 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7644 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7645 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7646 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7647 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7648
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007649verify [none|optional|required]
7650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7651 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7652 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7653 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7654 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007655 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7656 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7657 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7658 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007659
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020076605.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007661------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007663The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7664which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7665arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7666settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7667after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7668Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7669address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007671 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007672 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007674The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007675
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007676addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007677 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7678 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7679 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7680 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7681 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007683 Supported in default-server: No
7684
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007685agent-check
7686 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
7687 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
7688 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
7689 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
7690
7691 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
7692 e.g. "75%"
7693
7694 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
7695 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
7696
7697 * The string "drain".
7698
7699 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
7700 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
7701 persistence.
7702
7703 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
7704
7705 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
7706
7707 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
7708
7709 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
7710
7711 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
7712
7713 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
7714
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09007715 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
7716 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
7717 parameter.
7718
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007719 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
7720 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
7721
7722 Supported in default-server: No
7723
7724agent-inter <delay>
7725 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
7726 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7727
7728 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
7729 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
7730 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
7731 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7732 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
7733 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
7734 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
7735 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
7736 of backends use the same servers.
7737
7738 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
7739
7740 Supported in default-server: Yes
7741
7742agent-port <port>
7743 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
7744
7745 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
7746
7747 Supported in default-server: Yes
7748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007749backup
7750 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7751 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7752 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7753 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7754 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7755 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007757 Supported in default-server: No
7758
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007759ca-file <cafile>
7760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7761 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7762 server's certificate.
7763
7764 Supported in default-server: No
7765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007766check
7767 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007768 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7769 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7770 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7771 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7772 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7773 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7774 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007775 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7776 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7777 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007779 Supported in default-server: No
7780
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007781check-send-proxy
7782 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7783 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7784 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7785 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7786 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7787 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7788 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7789
7790 Supported in default-server: No
7791
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007792check-ssl
7793 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7794 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7795 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7796 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7797 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7798 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7799 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7800 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7801 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7802
7803 Supported in default-server: No
7804
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007805ciphers <ciphers>
7806 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7807 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7808 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7809 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7810 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7811 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7812 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7813 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7814
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007815 Supported in default-server: No
7816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007817cookie <value>
7818 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7819 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7820 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7821 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7822 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7823 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7824 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007826 Supported in default-server: No
7827
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007828crl-file <crlfile>
7829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7830 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7831 to verify server's certificate.
7832
7833 Supported in default-server: No
7834
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007835crt <cert>
7836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7837 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7838 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7839 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7840 certificate request.
7841
7842 Supported in default-server: No
7843
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007844disabled
7845 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7846 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7847 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7848 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7849 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7850
7851 Supported in default-server: No
7852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007853error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007854 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7855 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7856 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007858 Supported in default-server: Yes
7859
7860 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007862fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007863 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7864 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7865 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007867 Supported in default-server: Yes
7868
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007869force-sslv3
7870 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7871 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7872 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7873
7874 Supported in default-server: No
7875
7876force-tlsv10
7877 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7878 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7879
7880 Supported in default-server: No
7881
7882force-tlsv11
7883 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7884 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7885
7886 Supported in default-server: No
7887
7888force-tlsv12
7889 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7890 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7891
7892 Supported in default-server: No
7893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007894id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007895 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7896 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7897 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007899 Supported in default-server: No
7900
7901inter <delay>
7902fastinter <delay>
7903downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007904 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7905 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7906 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7907 between checks depending on the server state :
7908
7909 Server state | Interval used
7910 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7911 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7912 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7913 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7914 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7915 or yet unchecked. |
7916 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7917 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7918 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007920 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7921 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7922 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7923 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007924 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
7925 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
7926 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
7927 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
7928 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007930 Supported in default-server: Yes
7931
7932maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007933 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7934 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7935 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7936 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7937 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7938 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7939 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7940 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007942 Supported in default-server: Yes
7943
7944maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007945 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7946 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7947 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7948 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7949 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7950 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7951 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007953 Supported in default-server: Yes
7954
7955minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007956 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7957 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7958 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7959 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7960 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7961 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007962 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007963 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007965 Supported in default-server: Yes
7966
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007967no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007968 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7969 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007970 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007971
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007972 Supported in default-server: No
7973
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007974no-tls-tickets
7975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7976 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7977 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7978 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7979
7980 Supported in default-server: No
7981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007982no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007983 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007984 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7985 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007986 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7987 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007988
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007989 Supported in default-server: No
7990
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007991no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007992 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007993 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7994 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007995 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7996 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007997
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007998 Supported in default-server: No
7999
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008000no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008001 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008002 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8003 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008004 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8005 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008006
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008007 Supported in default-server: No
8008
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008009non-stick
8010 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8011 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8012 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8013
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008014 Supported in default-server: No
8015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008016observe <mode>
8017 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8018 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8019 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8020 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8021 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8022 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008023 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008025 Supported in default-server: No
8026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008027 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008029on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008030 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8031 Currently, four modes are available:
8032 - fastinter: force fastinter
8033 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8034 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8035 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8036 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008038 Supported in default-server: Yes
8039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008040 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8041
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008042on-marked-down <action>
8043 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8044 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008045 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8046 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8047 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8048 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8049 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8050 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8051 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8052 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008053
8054 Actions are disabled by default
8055
8056 Supported in default-server: Yes
8057
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008058on-marked-up <action>
8059 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8060 Currently one action is available:
8061 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8062 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8063 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8064 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8065 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8066 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8067 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8068 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8069
8070 Actions are disabled by default
8071
8072 Supported in default-server: Yes
8073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008074port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008075 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8076 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8077 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8078 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8079 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8080 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008082 Supported in default-server: Yes
8083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008084redir <prefix>
8085 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8086 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8087 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8088 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8089 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8090 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8091 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8092 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008093 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008094 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8095 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8096 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8097 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8098 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8099
8100 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008102 Supported in default-server: No
8103
8104rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008105 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8106 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8107 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008109 Supported in default-server: Yes
8110
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008111send-proxy
8112 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8113 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8114 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8115 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8116 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8117 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8118 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8119 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8120 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008121 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8122 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8123 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8124 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8125 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008126
8127 Supported in default-server: No
8128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008129slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008130 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8131 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8132 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8133 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8134 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8135 parameters :
8136
8137 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8138 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8139
8140 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8141 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8142 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8143 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8144
8145 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8146 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8147 seen as failed.
8148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008149 Supported in default-server: Yes
8150
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008151source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008152source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008153source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008154 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8155 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8156 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8157 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8158
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008159 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8160 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8161 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8162 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8163 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8164 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8165 server.
8166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008167 Supported in default-server: No
8168
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008169ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008170 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8171 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8172 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8173 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8174 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8175 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8176 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008177
8178 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008180track [<proxy>/]<server>
8181 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8182 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8183 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8184 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8185 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008187 Supported in default-server: No
8188
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008189verify [none|required]
8190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8191 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8192 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8193 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008194 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8195 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8196 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008197
8198 Supported in default-server: No
8199
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008200verifyhost <hostname>
8201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8202 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8203 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8204 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8205 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8206 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8207
8208 Supported in default-server: No
8209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008210weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008211 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8212 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8213 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008214 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8215 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8216 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8217 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8218 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8219 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008221 Supported in default-server: Yes
8222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008223
82246. HTTP header manipulation
8225---------------------------
8226
8227In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8228response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8229request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8230which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8231against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8232to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8233passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8234headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8235never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8236
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008237There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8238(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8239rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8240messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8241in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008242happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008243add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8244normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008246This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8247in section 4.2 :
8248
8249 - reqadd <string>
8250 - reqallow <search>
8251 - reqiallow <search>
8252 - reqdel <search>
8253 - reqidel <search>
8254 - reqdeny <search>
8255 - reqideny <search>
8256 - reqpass <search>
8257 - reqipass <search>
8258 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8259 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8260 - reqtarpit <search>
8261 - reqitarpit <search>
8262 - rspadd <string>
8263 - rspdel <search>
8264 - rspidel <search>
8265 - rspdeny <search>
8266 - rspideny <search>
8267 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8268 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8269
8270With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8271is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8272parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8273prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8274Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8275
8276 \t for a tab
8277 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8278 \n for a new line (LF)
8279 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8280 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8281 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8282 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8283 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8284
8285The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8286portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8287above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8288regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
82899 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8290is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8291
8292The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8293after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8294
8295Notes related to these keywords :
8296---------------------------------
8297 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8298 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8299 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8300
8301 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8302 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8303 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8304
8305 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8306 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8307 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8308 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8309 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8310
8311 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8312 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8313 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8314 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8315 useless headers before adding new ones.
8316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008317 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008318 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8319
8320 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8321 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8322 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8323
8324 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8325 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008326 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008327
8328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020083297. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8330----------------------------------
8331
8332Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8333client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8334The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8335these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8336but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8337data called patterns.
8338
8339
83407.1. ACL basics
8341---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008342
8343The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8344content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8345from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8346simple :
8347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008348 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008349 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008350 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8351 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008353The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8354adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008355
8356In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008358 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008359
8360This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8361Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8362and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008363an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8364conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8365as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8366are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008367
8368ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8369'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8370which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8371
8372There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8373performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008375The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8376specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8377this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008378methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8379ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008380
8381Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8382 - boolean
8383 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8384 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8385 - string
8386 - data block
8387
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008388Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8389converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8390would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8391The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8392which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008394The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8395 - boolean
8396 - integer or integer range
8397 - IP address / network
8398 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8399 - regular expression
8400 - hex block
8401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008402The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8403
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008404 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8405 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008406 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008407 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008409The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8410read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8411if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8412lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8413will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8414beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8415a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8416lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8417exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8418
8419Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8420loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8421
8422 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8423
8424In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8425the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8426case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8427as well.
8428
8429The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8430sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8431do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8432methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8433is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8434obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8435followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8436default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8437that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8438string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8439
8440There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8441sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8442be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008443
8444 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8445 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008446 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8447 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8448 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8449 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008450
8451 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8452 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008453 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008454
8455 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008456 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008457
8458 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008459 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008460
8461 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8462 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8463
8464 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8465 binary or string samples.
8466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008467 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8468 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008470 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8471 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8472 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008474 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8475 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008477 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8478 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008480 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8481 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008483 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8484 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008485 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008487 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8488 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8489 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008490
8491For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8492request, it is possible to do :
8493
8494 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8495
8496In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8497buffer, one would use the following acl :
8498
8499 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8500
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008501On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8502possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8503
8504 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008506All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8507criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8508method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8509to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8510criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8511the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008513If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8514the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8515example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008517 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8518 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8519 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8520 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008521
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008522
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008523The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008524and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8525combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8526the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008528 +-------------------------------------------------+
8529 | Input sample type |
8530 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8531 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8532 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8533 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8534 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8535 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | | |
8536 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8537 | integer (value) | int | *int | | | |
8538 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8539 | integer (length) | | | | len | len |
8540 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8541 | IP address | | | *ip | | |
8542 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8543 | exact string | | | | str | str |
8544 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8545 | prefix | | | | beg | beg |
8546 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8547 | suffix | | | | end | end |
8548 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8549 | substring | | | | sub | sub |
8550 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8551 | subdir | | | | dir | dir |
8552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8553 | domain | | | | dom | dom |
8554 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8555 | regex | | | | reg | reg |
8556 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8557 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008559
8560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085617.1.1. Matching booleans
8562------------------------
8563
8564In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8565Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8566When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8567that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8568
8569Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8570return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8571"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085747.1.2. Matching integers
8575------------------------
8576
8577Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8578enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8579to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8580
8581Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8582matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8583lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008584
8585For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8586unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8587representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8588
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008589As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8590two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8591instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8592ranges and operators.
8593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008594For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008595operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8596Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8597of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008599Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008600
8601 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8602 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8603 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8604 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8605 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008607For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008608
8609 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8610
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008611This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8612
8613 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086167.1.3. Matching strings
8617-----------------------
8618
8619String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8620different forms :
8621
8622 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8623 patterns ;
8624
8625 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8626 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8627
8628 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8629 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8630
8631 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8632 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8633
8634 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8635 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8636 matches.
8637
8638 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8639 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8640 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008641
8642String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8643exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8644characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8645string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8646to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008647before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008648
8649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086507.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8651---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008652
8653Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8654they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8655possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8656passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8657the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008658the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8659match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008660
8661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086627.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8663-------------------------------------
8664
8665It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8666not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8667a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8668to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8669digits may be used upper or lower case.
8670
8671Example :
8672 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8673 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8674
8675
86767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8677---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008678
8679IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8680netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8681within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008682host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008683difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8684at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8685does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8686parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008687
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008688IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8689Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8690trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8691IPv6 patterns.
8692
8693HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8694following situations :
8695 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8696 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8697 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8698 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8699 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8700 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8701 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8702 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8703 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8704 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008706
87077.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8708----------------------------------
8709
8710Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8711combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8712
8713 - AND (implicit)
8714 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8715 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008717A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008719 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008721Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8722indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008724For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8725"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8726requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8727is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
8728
8729 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8730 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8731 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8732 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
8733
8734To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8735and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
8736
8737 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8738 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8739 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8740 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
8741
8742 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8743 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8744 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8745 use_backend www if host_www
8746
8747It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8748expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8749be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8750the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
8751
8752 The following rule :
8753
8754 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8755 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8756
8757 Can also be written that way :
8758
8759 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8760
8761It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8762to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8763simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8764sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8765good use is the following :
8766
8767 With named ACLs :
8768
8769 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8770 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8771 monitor fail if site_dead
8772
8773 With anonymous ACLs :
8774
8775 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8776
8777See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
8778
8779
87807.3. Fetching samples
8781---------------------
8782
8783Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
8784against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
8785sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
8786ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
8787of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
8788available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
8789
8790This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
8791Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
8792compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
8793deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
8794
8795The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
8796matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
8797method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
8798indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
8799
8800As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
8801when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
8802mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
8803the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
8804ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
8805
8806Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
8807multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
8808when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
8809incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
8810are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
8811is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
8812all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
8813
8814Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
8815 - name
8816 - name(arg1)
8817 - name(arg1,arg2)
8818
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008819Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
8820of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
8821is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
8822was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
8823has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
8824unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
8825
8826These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
8827sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
8828the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
8829support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008831The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008833 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
8834 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8835 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008837 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
8838 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8839 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008841 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
8842 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
8843 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8844 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8845 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8846
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008847 http_date([<offset>])
8848 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
8849 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
8850 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
8851 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
8852 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
8853 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
8854 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
8855 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008856
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01008857 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
8858 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
8859 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
8860 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
8861 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
8862 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
8863 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
8864 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
8865 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
8866 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
8867 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
8868 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
8869 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
8870 the map* converters.
8871
8872 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
8873 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
8874 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
8875 the first matching occurrence will be used.
8876
8877 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
8878 | `-_ out | | | |
8879 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
8880 | / match `-_ | | | |
8881 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
8882 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
8883 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
8884 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
8885 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
8886 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
8887 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
8888 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
8889 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
8890 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
8891
8892 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
8893 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
8894 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
8895 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
8896 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
8897 trailing spaces/tabs.
8898
8899 Example :
8900
8901 # this is a comment and is ignored
8902 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
8903 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
8904 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
8905 | | | `----------- value
8906 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
8907 | `---------------------------- key
8908 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
8909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089107.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
8911--------------------------------------------
8912
8913A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
8914not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
8915"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
8916The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
8917
8918always_false : boolean
8919 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8920 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8921
8922always_true : boolean
8923 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8924 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8925
8926avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008927 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008928 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
8929 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
8930 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
8931 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
8932 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
8933 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
8934 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
8935 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
8936 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
8937 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
8938 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
8939 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
8940 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008942be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008943 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8944 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8945 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8946 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8947 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008949be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
8950 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8951 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8952 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
8953 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
8954 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
8955 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008956
8957 Example :
8958 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8959 backend dynamic
8960 mode http
8961 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8962 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008964connslots([<backend>]) : integer
8965 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
8966 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
8967 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
8968 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008969
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008970 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008971 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008972 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8973
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008974 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8975 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008976
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008977 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008978 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008979 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008980 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8981 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008982 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008983 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008984
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008985 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8986 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008987 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008988 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008989
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008990date([<offset>]) : integer
8991 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
8992 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
8993 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
8994 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008995 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
8996
8997 Example :
8998
8999 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9000 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009001
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009002env(<name>) : string
9003 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9004 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9005 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9006 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9007 certain way.
9008
9009 Examples :
9010 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9011 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9012
9013 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9014 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009016fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9017 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009018 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9019 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009020 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9021 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9022 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9023 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9024 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009026fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9027 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9028 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9029 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9030 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9031 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9032 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9033 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9034 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009035
9036 Example :
9037 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9038 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9039 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9040 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9041 frontend mail
9042 bind :25
9043 mode tcp
9044 maxconn 100
9045 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9046 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9047 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9048 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009050nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9051 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9052 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9053 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009054 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9055 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9056 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009058queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009059 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9060 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9061 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009062 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9063 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9064 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9065 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9066 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9067
9068srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9070 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9071 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9072 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9073 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9074 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9075 methods.
9076
9077srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9078 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9079 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9080 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9081 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9082 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9083 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9084 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9085
9086srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9087 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9088 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9089 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9090 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9091 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9092 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9093 overloading servers).
9094
9095 Example :
9096 # Redirect to a separate back
9097 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9098 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9099 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9100
9101table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9102 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9103 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9104
9105table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9106 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9107 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9108 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9109
9110
91117.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9112----------------------------------
9113
9114The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9115closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9116methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9117sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9118TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009119the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9120counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9121"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009122argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9123the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9124this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009125
9126be_id : integer
9127 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9128 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9129
9130dst : ip
9131 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9132 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9133 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9134 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9135 RFC 4291.
9136
9137dst_conn : integer
9138 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9139 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9140 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9141 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9142 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9143 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9144 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9145 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009147dst_port : integer
9148 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9149 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9150 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9151 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9152 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9153 an HTTP header.
9154
9155fe_id : integer
9156 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9157 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9158 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9159
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009160sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9161sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9162sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9163sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009164 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9165 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9166 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9167
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009168sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9169sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9170sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9171sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009172 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9173 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9174 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9175
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009176sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9177sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9178sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9179sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009180 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9181 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009182 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9183 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9184 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009185
9186 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9187 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009188 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9189 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9190 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009191 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9192 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9193
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009194sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9195sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9196sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9197sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009198 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9199 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9200
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009201sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9202sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9203sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9204sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009205 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9206 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9207 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9208
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009209sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9210sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9211sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9212sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009213 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9214 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9215 See also src_conn_rate.
9216
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009217sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9218sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9219sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9220sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009221 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009222 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009223
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009224sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9225sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9226sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9227sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009228 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9229 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9230 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009231 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9232 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9233 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009234
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009235sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9236sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9237sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9238sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009239 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9240 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9241 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9242
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009243sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9244sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9245sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9246sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009247 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9248 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9249 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9250 src_http_err_rate.
9251
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009252sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9253sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9254sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9255sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009256 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9257 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9258 src_http_req_cnt.
9259
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009260sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9261sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9262sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9263sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009264 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9265 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9266 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9267 src_http_req_rate.
9268
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009269sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9270sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9271sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9272sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009273 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009274 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9275 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9276 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9277 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009278
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009279 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9280 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009281 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9282
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009283sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9284sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9285sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9286sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009287 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9288 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9289 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9290 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9291
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009292sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9293sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9294sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9295sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009296 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9297 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9298 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9299 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9300
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009301sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9302sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9303sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9304sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009305 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9306 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9307 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9308 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009309 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009310 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9311
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009312sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9313sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9314sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9315sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009316 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9317 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9318 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9319 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9320 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009321 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009322
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009323sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9324sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9325sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9326sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009327 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9328 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9329 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9330
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009331sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9332sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9333sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9334sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009335 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9336 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009337 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009338 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9339 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009340 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9341 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9342 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009344so_id : integer
9345 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9346 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9347 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009349src : ip
9350 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9351 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9352 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9353 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9354 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9355 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9356 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009357
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009358 Example:
9359 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9360 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009362src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9363 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9364 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9365 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009366 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009368src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9369 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9370 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009371 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009372 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009374src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9375 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9376 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9377 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9378 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9379 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9380 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009381
9382 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9383 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9384 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9385 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009386 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009387 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9388 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009390src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009391 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009392 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009393 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009394 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009396src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009397 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009398 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9399 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009400 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009402src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9403 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9404 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9405 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009406 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009408src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009409 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009410 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009411 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009412 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009414src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009415 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009416 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009417 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9418 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009419 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9420 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9421 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009423src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9424 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9425 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009426 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009427 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009428 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009430src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9431 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9432 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9433 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9434 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009435 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009437src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9438 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9439 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9440 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009441 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009443src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9444 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9445 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9446 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009447 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009448 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009450src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9451 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9452 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9453 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009454 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009455 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9456 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009457
9458 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009459 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009460 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009462src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9463 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9464 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9465 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9466 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009467 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9468 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009470src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9471 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9472 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009473 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9474 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009475 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009477src_port : integer
9478 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9479 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9480 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9481 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009483src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9484 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009485 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9486 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9487 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009488 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009490src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9491 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9492 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9493 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9494 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009495 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009497src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9498 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9499 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9500 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9501 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9502 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9503 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9504 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9505 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009506
9507 Example :
9508 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9509 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9510 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9511 listen ssh
9512 bind :22
9513 mode tcp
9514 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009515 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009516 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009517 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009519srv_id : integer
9520 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9521 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9522 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009523
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095257.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9526----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009528The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9529closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9530when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9531usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9532future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009534ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9535 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9536 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9537 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9538 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9539 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009541ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9542 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9543 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9544 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9545 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547ssl_c_err : integer
9548 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9549 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9550 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9551 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9552 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009554ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9555 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9556 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9557 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9558 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9559 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9560 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9561 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9562 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009564 ACL derivatives :
9565 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009567ssl_c_key_alg : string
9568 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9569 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9570 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009572 ACL derivatives :
9573 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009575ssl_c_notafter : string
9576 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9577 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9578 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009580 ACL derivatives :
9581 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583ssl_c_notbefore : string
9584 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9585 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9586 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009588 ACL derivatives :
9589 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009591ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9592 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9593 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9594 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9595 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9596 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9597 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9598 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9599 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009601 ACL derivatives :
9602 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009604ssl_c_serial : binary
9605 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9606 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9607 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009609 ACL derivatives :
9610 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009612ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9613 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9614 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9615 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009617ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9618 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9619 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9620 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009622 ACL derivatives :
9623 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9624
9625ssl_c_used : boolean
9626 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9627 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629ssl_c_verify : integer
9630 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9631 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9632 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9633 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635ssl_c_version : integer
9636 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9637 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9640 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9641 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9642 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9643 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009644 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9646 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9647 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009649 ACL derivatives :
9650 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009652ssl_f_key_alg : string
9653 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9654 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9655 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657 ACL derivatives :
9658 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009660ssl_f_notafter : string
9661 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9662 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9663 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009665 ACL derivatives :
9666 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668ssl_f_notbefore : string
9669 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9670 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9671 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009673 ACL derivatives :
9674 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009676ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9677 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9678 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9679 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9680 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9681 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9682 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9683 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9684 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009686 ACL derivatives :
9687 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009689ssl_f_serial : binary
9690 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9691 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9692 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009694 ACL derivatives :
9695 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009697ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9698 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9699 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9700 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009702 ACL derivatives :
9703 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009705ssl_f_version : integer
9706 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9707 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9708
9709ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009710 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9711 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9712 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009714 Example :
9715 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9716 listen http-https
9717 bind :80
9718 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9719 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9720
9721ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9722 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9723 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9724
9725ssl_fc_alpn : string
9726 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
9727 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
9728 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
9729 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
9730 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
9731 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
9732 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
9733 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
9734 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
9735
9736 ACL derivatives :
9737 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009739ssl_fc_cipher : string
9740 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
9741 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009743 ACL derivatives :
9744 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009746ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009747 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
9748 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009749 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
9750 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
9751 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
9752 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009754ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
9755 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009756 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
9757 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
9758 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9759 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761ssl_fc_npn : string
9762 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
9763 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
9764 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
9765 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9766 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
9767 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
9768 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
9769 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009771 ACL derivatives :
9772 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009774ssl_fc_protocol : string
9775 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
9776 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009778 ACL derivatives :
9779 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
9780
9781ssl_fc_session_id : binary
9782 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
9783 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
9784 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
9785 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009787ssl_fc_sni : string
9788 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
9789 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9790 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
9791 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
9792 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
9793
9794 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
9795 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
9796 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02009797 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
9798 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009800 ACL derivatives :
9801 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
9802 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
9803 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009805ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
9806 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
9807 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009808
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098107.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
9811------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009813Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
9814sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
9815only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
9816For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
9817be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
9818can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
9819sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
9820for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
9821content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009823payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
9824 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
9825 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
9826 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009828payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
9829 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
9830 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
9831 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009833req.len : integer
9834req_len : integer (deprecated)
9835 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9836 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9837 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9838 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9839 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9840 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9841 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
9842 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009844req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9845 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009846 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9847 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9848 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9849 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009851 ACL alternatives :
9852 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009854req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9855 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9856 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9857 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9858 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009860 ACL alternatives :
9861 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009863 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009865req.proto_http : boolean
9866req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
9867 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
9868 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
9869 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
9870 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
9871 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
9872 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
9873 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009875 Example:
9876 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9877 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9878 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009879 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009881req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
9882rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9883 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
9884 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
9885 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
9886 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
9887 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
9888 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
9889 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009891 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
9892 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
9893 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9894 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
9895 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
9896 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009898 ACL derivatives :
9899 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009901 Example :
9902 listen tse-farm
9903 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9904 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9905 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9906 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9907 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9908 persist rdp-cookie
9909 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9910 # This is only useful makes sense if
9911 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9912 stick-table type string size 204800
9913 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9914 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9915 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009917 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
9918 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009920req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
9921rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
9922 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
9923 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
9924 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
9925 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009927 ACL derivatives :
9928 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009930req.ssl_hello_type : integer
9931req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9932 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9933 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
9934 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9935 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9936 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
9937 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9938 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009940req.ssl_sni : string
9941req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
9942 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
9943 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
9944 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
9945 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9946 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9947 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
9948 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
9949 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
9950 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
9951 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
9952 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
9953 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955 ACL derivatives :
9956 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009958 Examples :
9959 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
9960 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9961 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
9962 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
9963 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009965res.ssl_hello_type : integer
9966rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9967 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9968 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
9969 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9970 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9971 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
9972 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9973 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009975req.ssl_ver : integer
9976req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
9977 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
9978 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
9979 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
9980 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
9981 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9982 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9983 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
9984 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
9985 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009987 ACL derivatives :
9988 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009989
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +02009990res.len : integer
9991 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9992 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9993 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9994 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9995 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9996 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9997 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
9998 content inspection.
9999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10001 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010002 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10003 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10004 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10005 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010007res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10008 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10009 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10010 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10011 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010015wait_end : boolean
10016 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10017 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10018 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10019 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10020 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10021 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10022 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10023 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010025 Examples :
10026 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10027 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10028 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010030 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10031 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10032 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10033 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10034 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10035 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10036 tcp-request content reject
10037
10038
100397.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10040--------------------------------------
10041
10042It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10043This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10044data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10045its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10046HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10047content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10048to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10049more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10050response are indexed.
10051
10052base : string
10053 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10054 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10055 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10056 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10057 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10058 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10059 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10060 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10061
10062 ACL derivatives :
10063 base : exact string match
10064 base_beg : prefix match
10065 base_dir : subdir match
10066 base_dom : domain match
10067 base_end : suffix match
10068 base_len : length match
10069 base_reg : regex match
10070 base_sub : substring match
10071
10072base32 : integer
10073 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10074 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10075 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10076 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10077
10078base32+src : binary
10079 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10080 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10081 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10082 per-URL counters.
10083
10084req.cook([<name>]) : string
10085cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10086 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10087 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10088 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10089 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10090 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10091 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10092 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10093 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10094
10095 ACL derivatives :
10096 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10097 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10098 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10099 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10100 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10101 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10102 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10103 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010105req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10106cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10107 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10108 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010110req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10111cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10112 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10113 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10114 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10115 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010117cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10118 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10119 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10120 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10121 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10122 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10123 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10124 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10125 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10126 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10127 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10130 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10131 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10132 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10133 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10134 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010136req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10137 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10138 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10139 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10140 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10141 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10142 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10143 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10144 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010146req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10147 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10148 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10149 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10150 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010152req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10153 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10154 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10155 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10156 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10157 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10158 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10159 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10160 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10161 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10162 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10163 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165 ACL derivatives :
10166 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10167 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10168 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10169 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10170 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10171 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10172 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10173 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10174
10175req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10176hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10177 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10178 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10179 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10180 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10181 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10182 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10183 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10184 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10185 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10186
10187req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10188hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10189 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10190 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10191 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10192 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10193 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10194 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10195 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10196 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10197
10198req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10199hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10200 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10201 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10202 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10203 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10204 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10205 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10206 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10207
10208http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10209 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10210 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10211 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10212 basic auth is supported.
10213
10214http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10215 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10216 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10217 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10218 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10219 basic auth is supported.
10220
10221 ACL derivatives :
10222 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10223
10224http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010225 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10226 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010227 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10228 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230method : integer + string
10231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10232 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10233 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10234 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10235 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10236 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10237 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010239 ACL derivatives :
10240 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010242 Example :
10243 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10244 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10245 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010247path : string
10248 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10249 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10250 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10251 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10252 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10253 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10254 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010256 ACL derivatives :
10257 path : exact string match
10258 path_beg : prefix match
10259 path_dir : subdir match
10260 path_dom : domain match
10261 path_end : suffix match
10262 path_len : length match
10263 path_reg : regex match
10264 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010266req.ver : string
10267req_ver : string (deprecated)
10268 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10269 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10270 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272 ACL derivatives :
10273 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275res.comp : boolean
10276 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10277 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10278 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010280res.comp_algo : string
10281 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10282 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10283 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285res.cook([<name>]) : string
10286scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10287 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10288 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10289 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010291 ACL derivatives :
10292 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010294res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10295scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10296 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10297 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10298 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010300res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10301scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10302 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10303 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10304 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010306res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10307 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10308 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10309 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10310 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10311 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10312 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10313 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10314 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10315 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10318 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10319 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10320 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10321 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10322 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010324res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10325shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10326 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10327 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10328 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10329 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10330 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10331 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10332 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10333 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010335 ACL derivatives :
10336 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10337 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10338 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10339 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10340 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10341 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10342 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10343 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10344
10345res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10346shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10347 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10348 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10349 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10350 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10351 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010353res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10354shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10355 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10356 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10357 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10358 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10359 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10360 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010362res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10363shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10364 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10365 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10366 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10367 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10368 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10369 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010371res.ver : string
10372resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10373 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10374 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010376 ACL derivatives :
10377 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10380 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10381 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10382 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10383 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010385 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10386 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010388 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010390status : integer
10391 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10392 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10393 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010395url : string
10396 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10397 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10398 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10399 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10400 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10401 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10402 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010404 ACL derivatives :
10405 url : exact string match
10406 url_beg : prefix match
10407 url_dir : subdir match
10408 url_dom : domain match
10409 url_end : suffix match
10410 url_len : length match
10411 url_reg : regex match
10412 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010414url_ip : ip
10415 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10416 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10417 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10418 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10419 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10420 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10421 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010423url_port : integer
10424 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10425 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10426 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10427 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010429urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10430url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10431 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10432 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10433 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10434 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10435 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10436 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10437 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10438 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10439 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010441 ACL derivatives :
10442 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10443 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10444 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10445 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10446 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10447 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10448 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10449 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010450
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452 Example :
10453 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10454 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10455 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10456 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010458urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10459 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10460 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10461 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010462
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104647.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010465---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010467Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10468every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010469order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010471ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10472---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010473FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010474HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010475HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10476HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010477HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10478HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10479HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10480HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10481LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010482METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10483METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10484METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10485METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10486METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10487METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010488RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010489REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010490TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010491WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10492---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010493
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104958. Logging
10496----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010497
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010498One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10499provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10500very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10501provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10502state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010503to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010504headers.
10505
10506In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10507about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10508send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10509
10510 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10511 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10512 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10513 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10514 at the termination.
10515
10516The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10517allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10518as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10519while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10520real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10521delay.
10522
10523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105248.1. Log levels
10525---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010526
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010527TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010528source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010529HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10530in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10531track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10532syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10533about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010534
10535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105368.2. Log formats
10537----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010538
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010539HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010540and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10541slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10542options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010543
10544 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10545 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10546 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10547 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10548 extents.
10549
10550 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10551 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10552 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10553 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10554 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10555
10556 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10557 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10558 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10559 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10560 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10561
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010562 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10563 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10564 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10565 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10566
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010567 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10568
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010569Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10570specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10571field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10572servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10573always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10574identifier.
10575
10576Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10577 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10578 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10579 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10580 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10581
10582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105838.2.1. Default log format
10584-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010585
10586This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10587as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10588format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10589
10590 Example :
10591 listen www
10592 mode http
10593 log global
10594 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10595
10596 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10597 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10598 (www/HTTP)
10599
10600 Field Format Extract from the example above
10601 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10602 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10603 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10604 4 'to' to
10605 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10606 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10607
10608Detailed fields description :
10609 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10610 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10611 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10612 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10613 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10614 and processed the connection.
10615 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10616
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010617In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10618"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10619connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10620
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010621It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10622will eventually disappear.
10623
10624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106258.2.2. TCP log format
10626---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010627
10628The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10629is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10630information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10631counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10632emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10633environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10634the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10635sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010636specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10637not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10638fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10639marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010640
10641 Example :
10642 frontend fnt
10643 mode tcp
10644 option tcplog
10645 log global
10646 default_backend bck
10647
10648 backend bck
10649 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10650
10651 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10652 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10653 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10654
10655 Field Format Extract from the example above
10656 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10657 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10658 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10659 4 frontend_name fnt
10660 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10661 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10662 7 bytes_read* 212
10663 8 termination_state --
10664 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10665 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10666
10667Detailed fields description :
10668 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010669 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10670 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10671 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10672 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10673 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010674
10675 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010676 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10677 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10678 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010679
10680 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10681 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10682 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10683 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10684
10685 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10686 and processed the connection.
10687
10688 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10689 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10690 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10691 applications.
10692
10693 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10694 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10695 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10696 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10697 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10698
10699 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10700 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10701 See "Timers" below for more details.
10702
10703 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10704 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10705 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10706 "Timers" below for more details.
10707
10708 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10709 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10710 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10711 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10712 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10713 details.
10714
10715 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10716 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10717 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10718 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10719 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10720
10721 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10722 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10723 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10724 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10725 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10726 for more details.
10727
10728 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010729 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010730 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10731 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10732 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010733 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010734
10735 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10736 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10737 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10738 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10739 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10740 caused by a denial of service attack.
10741
10742 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10743 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10744 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10745 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10746 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10747 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10748 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10749 denial of service attack.
10750
10751 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10752 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10753 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10754 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10755 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10756 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10757 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10758 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10759 be processed than on other servers.
10760
10761 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10762 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10763 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10764 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10765 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10766 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10767 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10768 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10769 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10770 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10771 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10772 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10773 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10774
10775 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10776 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10777 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10778 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10779 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10780 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10781 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10782 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10783
10784 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10785 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10786 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10787 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10788 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10789 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10790 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10791 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10792 occurs.
10793
10794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107958.2.3. HTTP log format
10796----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010797
10798The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10799is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10800the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10801are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10802emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10803generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10804"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10805which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010806frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10807is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010808
10809Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10810slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10811with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10812
10813 Example :
10814 frontend http-in
10815 mode http
10816 option httplog
10817 log global
10818 default_backend bck
10819
10820 backend static
10821 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10822
10823 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10824 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10825 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010826 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010827
10828 Field Format Extract from the example above
10829 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10830 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10831 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10832 4 frontend_name http-in
10833 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10834 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10835 7 status_code 200
10836 8 bytes_read* 2750
10837 9 captured_request_cookie -
10838 10 captured_response_cookie -
10839 11 termination_state ----
10840 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10841 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10842 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10843 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10844 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010845
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010846
10847Detailed fields description :
10848 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010849 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10850 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10851 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10852 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10853 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010854
10855 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010856 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10857 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10858 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010859
10860 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10861 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10862 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10863 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10864 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10865
10866 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10867 and processed the connection.
10868
10869 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10870 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10871 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10872
10873 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10874 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10875 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10876 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10877 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10878 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10879
10880 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10881 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10882 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10883 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10884 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10885 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10886
10887 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10888 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10889 See "Timers" below for more details.
10890
10891 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10892 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10893 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10894 below for more details.
10895
10896 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10897 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10898 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10899 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10900 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10901 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10902 for more details.
10903
10904 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10905 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10906 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10907 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10908 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10909 details.
10910
10911 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10912 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10913 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10914
10915 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10916 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10917 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10918 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10919 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10920 overflowing.
10921
10922 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10923 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10924 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10925 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10926 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10927 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10928 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10929 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10930
10931 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10932 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10933 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10934 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10935 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10936 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10937 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10938 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10939
10940 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10941 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10942 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10943 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10944 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10945 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10946 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10947
10948 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010949 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010950 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10951 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10952 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010953 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010954 system.
10955
10956 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10957 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10958 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10959 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10960 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10961 caused by a denial of service attack.
10962
10963 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10964 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10965 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10966 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10967 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10968 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10969 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10970 denial of service attack.
10971
10972 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10973 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10974 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10975 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10976 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10977 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10978 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10979 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10980 processed than on other servers.
10981
10982 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10983 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10984 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10985 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10986 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10987 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10988 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10989 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10990 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10991 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10992 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10993 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10994 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10995
10996 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10997 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10998 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10999 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11000 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11001 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11002 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11003 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11004
11005 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11006 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11007 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11008 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11009 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11010 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11011 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11012 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11013 occurs.
11014
11015 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11016 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11017 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11018 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11019 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11020 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11021 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11022 cookies" below for more details.
11023
11024 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11025 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11026 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11027 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11028 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11029 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11030 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11031 and cookies" below for more details.
11032
11033 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11034 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11035 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11036 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11037 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11038 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11039 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11040 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11041
11042
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200110438.2.4. Custom log format
11044------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011045
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011046The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011047mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011048
11049HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11050Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11051separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11052prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11053
11054Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11055variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11056string formats ("Q").
11057
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011058If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011059as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011060less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11061the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11062
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011063Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011064In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11065in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011066
11067Flags are :
11068 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011069 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011070
11071 Example:
11072
11073 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11074 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11075
11076At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11077
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011078 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11079 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011080
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011081the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011082
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011083 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011084 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011085 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011086
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011087and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11088
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011089 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011090 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11091
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011092Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11093
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011094 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011095 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011096 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11097 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11098 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011099 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11100 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11101 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011102 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011103 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011104 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011105 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011106 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011107 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011108 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11109 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011110 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011111 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11112 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011113 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011114 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11115 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011116 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11117 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11118 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011119 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011120 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11121 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011122 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011123 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11124 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11125 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011126 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011127 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11128 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11129 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11130 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011131 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011132 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011133 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011134 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011135 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011136 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011137 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11138 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11139 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011140 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011141 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11142 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011143 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011144 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011145 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011146 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011147
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011148 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011149
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011150
111518.2.5. Error log format
11152-----------------------
11153
11154When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11155protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11156By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11157"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11158will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11159logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11160
11161The format looks like this :
11162
11163 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11164 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11165 Connection error during SSL handshake
11166
11167 Field Format Extract from the example above
11168 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11169 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11170 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11171 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11172 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11173
11174These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11175failures.
11176
11177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111788.3. Advanced logging options
11179-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011180
11181Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11182just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11183options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11184for more information about their usage.
11185
11186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111878.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11188------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011189
11190It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11191haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11192commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11193monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11194ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11195
11196 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11197 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11198 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11199 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11200
11201 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11202 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11203 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11204 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11205 such as other load-balancers.
11206
11207 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11208 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11209 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11210
11211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112128.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11213----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011214
11215The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11216what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11217or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11218"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11219just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11220log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11221after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11222is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11223with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11224with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11225
11226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112278.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11228------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011229
11230Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11231for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11232"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11233retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11234raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11235a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11236file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11237you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11238"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11239
11240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112418.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11242--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011243
11244Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11245multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11246them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11247"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11248logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11249error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11250and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11251too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11252useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11253alternative.
11254
11255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112568.4. Timing events
11257------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011258
11259Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11260reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11261the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11262frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11263mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11264
11265 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11266 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11267 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11268 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11269 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11270
11271 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11272 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11273 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11274 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11275 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11276
11277 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11278 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11279 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11280 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11281 connection never established.
11282
11283 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11284 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11285 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11286 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11287 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11288 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11289 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11290 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11291 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11292 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11293 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11294
11295 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11296 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11297 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11298 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11299 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11300
11301 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11302
11303 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11304 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11305 negative.
11306
11307These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11308protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11309that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011310due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011311close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11312session has been aborted on timeout.
11313
11314Most common cases :
11315
11316 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11317 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11318 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11319 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11320 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11321 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11322 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11323 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11324 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011325 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11326 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11327 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011328
11329 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11330 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11331 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11332 of ms on remote networks.
11333
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011334 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11335 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11336 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011337
11338 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11339 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11340 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11341 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11342 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11343 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11344 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11345 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11346 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11347 to the server until another one is released.
11348
11349Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11350
11351 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11352 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11353 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11354
11355 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11356 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11357 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11358
11359 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11360 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11361 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11362 flags.
11363
11364 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11365 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11366 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11367 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11368 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11369 the client connection was maintained open.
11370
11371 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11372 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11373 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11374 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11375
11376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113778.5. Session state at disconnection
11378-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011379
11380TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11381"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
113822-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11383each of which has a special meaning :
11384
11385 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11386 session to terminate :
11387
11388 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11389
11390 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11391 server explicitly refused it.
11392
11393 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11394 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11395 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11396 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011397 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11398
11399 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11400 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011401
11402 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11403 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11404 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11405 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11406 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11407
11408 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11409 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11410 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11411 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11412 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11413
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011414 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11415 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11416
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011417 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11418 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11419 backup connections when going up.
11420
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011421 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11422
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011423 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11424 send or receive data.
11425
11426 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11427 send or receive data.
11428
11429 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11430 with nothing left in the buffers.
11431
11432 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11433
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011434 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011435 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11436
11437 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11438 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11439 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11440 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11441 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11442
11443 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11444 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11445
11446 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11447 server (HTTP only).
11448
11449 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11450
11451 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11452 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11453 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11454
11455 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11456 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11457 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11458
11459 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11460
11461 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11462 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11463
11464 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11465 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11466 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11467
11468 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11469 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011470 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11471 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011472
11473 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11474 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11475 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11476 another server.
11477
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011478 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011479 server.
11480
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011481 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11482 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11483 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11484 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11485
11486 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11487 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11488 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11489 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11490
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011491 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11492 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11493 "use-server" rule).
11494
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011495 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11496
11497 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11498 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11499
11500 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11501
11502 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11503 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11504 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11505
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011506 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11507 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11508 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11509 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11510 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11511
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011512 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11513
11514 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11515 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11516
11517 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11518
11519 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11520
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011521The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11522was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011523helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11524starvation, attacks, etc...
11525
11526The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11527alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11528easier finding and understanding.
11529
11530 Flags Reason
11531
11532 -- Normal termination.
11533
11534 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11535 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11536 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11537 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11538
11539 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11540 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11541 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11542 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11543 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11544 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011545
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011546 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11547 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011548 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011549
11550 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11551 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11552 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11553
11554 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11555 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11556 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11557 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11558 the server takes too long to respond.
11559
11560 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11561 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11562 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11563 long a time to respond.
11564
11565 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11566 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11567 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11568 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11569 and the client.
11570
11571 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11572 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11573 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11574 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11575 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11576 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11577
11578 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11579 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011580 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11581 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11582 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11583 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011584
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011585 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11586 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011588 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011589 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11590 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11591 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11592 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11593 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11594
11595 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11596 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11597 503 or 504 here.
11598
11599 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11600 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11601 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11602 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11603 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11604
11605 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11606 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011607 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011608 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11609 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11610
11611 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11612 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11613 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11614 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11615 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11616 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11617 between haproxy and the server.
11618
11619 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11620 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11621 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11622 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11623 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11624 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11625 solution is to fix the application.
11626
11627 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11628 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11629 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11630 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11631 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11632 external attacks.
11633
11634 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11635 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011636 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011637 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11638 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11639
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011640 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11641 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11642 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011643 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11644 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011645
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011646 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11647 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11648 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11649 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011650 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11651 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11652 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11653 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11654 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011655
11656 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11657 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11658 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11659 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11660
11661 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11662 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11663 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11664 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11665
11666 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11667 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11668 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11669 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11670
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011671The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11672persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11673important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11674re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11675
11676 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11677
11678 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11679 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11680 set on a GET request.
11681
11682 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11683 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011684 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011685 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11686
11687 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11688 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11689 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11690
11691 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11692 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11693 already got a cookie.
11694
11695 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11696 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11697 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11698 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11699 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11700
11701 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11702 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11703 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11704
11705 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11706 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11707 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11708
11709 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11710 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11711
11712 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11713 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11714 then advertised in the response.
11715
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117178.6. Non-printable characters
11718-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011719
11720In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11721consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11722converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11723prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11724being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11725escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11726is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11727'}' when logging headers.
11728
11729Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11730issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11731containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11732
11733Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11734the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11735performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11736
11737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117388.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11739---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011740
11741Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11742achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011743section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011744cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11745the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11746the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011747locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011748not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11749user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11750a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11751wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11752
11753 Examples :
11754 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11755 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11756
11757 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11758 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11759
11760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117618.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11762---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011763
11764Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11765proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11766the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11767server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11768
11769Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11770response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011771section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011772
11773It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011774time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11775appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011776are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11777and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11778follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11779request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11780in the logs.
11781
11782 Example :
11783 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11784 listen proxy-out
11785 mode http
11786 option httplog
11787 option logasap
11788 log global
11789 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11790
11791 # log the name of the virtual server
11792 capture request header Host len 20
11793
11794 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11795 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11796
11797 # log the beginning of the referrer
11798 capture request header Referer len 20
11799
11800 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11801 capture response header Server len 20
11802
11803 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11804 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11805
11806 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11807 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11808
11809 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11810 capture response header Via len 20
11811
11812 # log the URL location during a redirection
11813 capture response header Location len 20
11814
11815 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11816 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11817 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11818 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11819 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11820
11821 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11822 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11823 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11824 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011825 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011826
11827 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11828 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11829 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11830 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11831 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011832 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011833
11834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118358.9. Examples of logs
11836---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011837
11838These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11839them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11840reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11841
11842 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11843 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11844 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11845
11846 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11847 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11848
11849 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11850 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11851 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11852
11853 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11854 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11855
11856 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11857 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11858 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11859
11860 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011861 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011862 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11863 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11864
11865 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11866 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11867 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11868
11869 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11870 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011871 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011872 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11873 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11874 to return the 502 and not the server.
11875
11876 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011877 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011878
11879 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11880 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11881 Nothing was sent to any server.
11882
11883 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11884 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11885
11886 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11887 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11888 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11889 send a 408 return code to the client.
11890
11891 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11892 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11893
11894 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11895 5 seconds ("c----").
11896
11897 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11898 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011899 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011900
11901 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011902 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011903 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11904 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11905 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11906 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11907 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011908
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119109. Statistics and monitoring
11911----------------------------
11912
11913It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11914mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11915CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11916Unix socket.
11917
11918
119199.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011920---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011921
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011922The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11923page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011925 0. pxname: proxy name
11926 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11927 for server)
11928 2. qcur: current queued requests
11929 3. qmax: max queued requests
11930 4. scur: current sessions
11931 5. smax: max sessions
11932 6. slim: sessions limit
11933 7. stot: total sessions
11934 8. bin: bytes in
11935 9. bout: bytes out
11936 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011937 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011938 12. ereq: request errors
11939 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011940 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011941 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11942 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011943 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011944 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11945 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11946 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11947 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11948 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11949 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11950 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11951 25. qlimit: queue limit
11952 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11953 27. iid: unique proxy id
11954 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11955 29. throttle: warm up status
11956 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11957 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011958 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011959 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11960 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11961 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011962 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011963 UNK -> unknown
11964 INI -> initializing
11965 SOCKERR -> socket error
11966 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11967 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11968 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11969 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11970 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11971 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11972 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11973 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11974 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11975 disable-on-404
11976 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11977 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11978 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011979 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11980 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011981 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11982 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11983 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11984 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11985 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11986 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011987 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11988 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11989 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11990 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011991 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11992 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011993 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11994 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11995 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011996 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011997
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119999.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012000-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012001
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012002The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12003necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12004A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12005issuing commands by hand :
12006
12007 global
12008 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12009 stats timeout 2m
12010
12011It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12012the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12013never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12014situations :
12015
12016 global
12017 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12018 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12019 stats timeout 2m
12020
12021To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12022swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12023to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12024syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12025
12026 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12027 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12028
12029The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12030script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12031for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12032
12033The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12034that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12035editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12036(eg: watch a counter).
12037
12038The socket supports two operation modes :
12039 - interactive
12040 - non-interactive
12041
12042The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12043this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12044sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12045mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12046commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12047example :
12048
12049 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12050
12051The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12052entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12053for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12054sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12055"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12056after processing the last command of the same line.
12057
12058For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12059"prompt" command :
12060
12061 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12062 prompt
12063 > show info
12064 ...
12065 >
12066
12067Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12068delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12069that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12070parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012071
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012072It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12073on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12074own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012075
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012076The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12077If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12078all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12079it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12080
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012081clear counters
12082 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12083 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12084 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12085 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12086 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12087
12088clear counters all
12089 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12090 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12091 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12092
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012093clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12094 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12095
12096 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12097 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12098 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12099 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12100 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12101 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12102
12103 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12104
12105 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12106 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12107 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12108 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12109 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12110 the ACLs :
12111
12112 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12113 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12114 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12115 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12116 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12117 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12118
12119 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012120 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12121 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012122
12123 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012124 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012125 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012126 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12127 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12128 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12129 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012130
12131 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12132
12133 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012134 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012135 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12136 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012137 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12138 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12139 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012140
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012141enable agent <backend>/<server>
12142 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12143
12144 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12145 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12146 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12147 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12148 re-enabled using enable agent.
12149
12150 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12151 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12152 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12153 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12154 otherwise unchanged.
12155
12156 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12157 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12158 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12159
12160 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12161 level "admin".
12162
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012163disable frontend <frontend>
12164 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12165 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12166 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12167 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12168 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12169 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12170 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12171 on the stats page.
12172
12173 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12174 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12175
12176 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12177 level "admin".
12178
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012179disable server <backend>/<server>
12180 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12181 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12182 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12183 during the maintenance.
12184
12185 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12186 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12187
12188 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012189 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012190
12191 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12192 level "admin".
12193
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012194enable agent <backend>/<server>
12195 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12196
12197 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12198 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12199
12200 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12201 level "admin".
12202
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012203enable frontend <frontend>
12204 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12205 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12206 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12207 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12208 which was disabled.
12209
12210 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12211 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12212
12213 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12214 level "admin".
12215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012216enable server <backend>/<server>
12217 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12218 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12219
12220 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012221 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012222
12223 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12224 level "admin".
12225
12226get weight <backend>/<server>
12227 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12228 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12229 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12230 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12231 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012232 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012233
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012234help
12235 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12236 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012237
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012238prompt
12239 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12240 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12241 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12242 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12243 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12244 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12245 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12246 command.
12247
12248quit
12249 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012250
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012251set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012252 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12253 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12254 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12255 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12256 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012257 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12258 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12259
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012260set maxconn global <maxconn>
12261 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12262 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12263 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12264 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12265 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12266 setting.
12267
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012268set rate-limit connections global <value>
12269 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12270 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12271 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12272 is passed in number of connections per second.
12273
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012274set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12275 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12276 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012277 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12278 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012279
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012280set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012281 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12282 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12283 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12284 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012285 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12286 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012288set timeout cli <delay>
12289 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12290 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12291 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12292
12293set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12294 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12295 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012296 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12297 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12298 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12299 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12300 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12301 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12302 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12303 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12304 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12305 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12306 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12307 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12308 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012309
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012310show errors [<iid>]
12311 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12312 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012313 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12314 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12315 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012316
12317 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12318 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12319 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12320 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12321 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12322 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12323 are reported too.
12324
12325 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12326 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12327 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12328 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12329 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12330 code.
12331
12332 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12333 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12334 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12335 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12336 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12337 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12338 line.
12339
12340 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012341 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12342 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012343 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12344 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12345
12346 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12347 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12348 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12349 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12350 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12351 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12352 00204+ minal\r\n
12353 00211 \r\n
12354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012355 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012356 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12357 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12358 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12359 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12360 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12361 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012362
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012363show info
12364 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12365
12366show sess
12367 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012368 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12369 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12370
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012371show sess <id>
12372 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12373 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12374 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12375 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12376 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012377 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12378 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12379 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012380
12381show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12382 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12383 possible to dump only selected items :
12384 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12385 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12386 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12387 for example:
12388 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12389 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12390 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12391
12392 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012393 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12394 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012395 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12396 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12397 Nbproc: 1
12398 Process_num: 1
12399 (...)
12400
12401 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12402 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12403 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12404 (...)
12405 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12406
12407 $
12408
12409 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12410 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12411 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12412 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012413 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012414
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012415show table
12416 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12417 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12418 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12419 entries currently in use.
12420
12421 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012422 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012423 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12424 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012425
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012426show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012427 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12428 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12429 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012430 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12431
12432 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12433 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12434 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12435 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12436 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12437
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012438 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12439 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12440 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12441 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12442 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12443 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12444
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012445
12446 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012447 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12448 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012449
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012450 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012451 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012452 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012453 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12454 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12455 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12456 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012457
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012458 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012459 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012460 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12461 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012462
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012463 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12464 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012465 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012466 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12467 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012468
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012469 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12470 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012471 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012472 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12473 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12474
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012475 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12476 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12477 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12478 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12479 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12480
12481 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12482 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12483 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012484 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12485 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012486 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12487 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012488
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012489shutdown frontend <frontend>
12490 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12491 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12492 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12493 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12494 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12495 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12496 once it is terminated.
12497
12498 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12499 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12500
12501 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12502 level "admin".
12503
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012504shutdown session <id>
12505 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12506 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12507 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12508 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12509 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12510 flag in the logs.
12511
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012512shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12513 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12514 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12515 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12516 'K' flag in the logs.
12517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012518/*
12519 * Local variables:
12520 * fill-column: 79
12521 * End:
12522 */